blob: 6cf096cdf8dae7668481fd91197aa55731567bb7 [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2013
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02005# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0+
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006#
7
8Summary:
9========
10
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000011This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000012Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
13processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
14initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
15code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000016
17The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000018the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
19header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000020support booting of Linux images.
21
22Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
23configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
24implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
25add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
26code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
27load and run it dynamically.
28
29
30Status:
31=======
32
33In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000035"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
36
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000037In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +020038who contributed the specific port. The boards.cfg file lists board
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010039maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000040
Robert P. J. Dayadb9d852012-11-14 02:03:20 +000041Note: There is no CHANGELOG file in the actual U-Boot source tree;
42it can be created dynamically from the Git log using:
43
44 make CHANGELOG
45
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000046
47Where to get help:
48==================
49
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
51U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050052<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
53on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
54Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
55http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
57
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010058Where to get source code:
59=========================
60
61The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
62git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
63http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
64
65The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020066any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010067available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
68directory.
69
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010070Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010071ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
72
73
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000074Where we come from:
75===================
76
77- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000078- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000079- clean up code
80- make it easier to add custom boards
81- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
82- extend functions, especially:
83 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
84 * S-Record download
85 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020086 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000087- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000088- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +020090- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000091
92
93Names and Spelling:
94===================
95
96The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
97"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
98in source files etc.). Example:
99
100 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
101
102File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
103
104 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
105
106 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
107
108Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
109the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
110
111 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
112 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000113
114
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000115Versioning:
116===========
117
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200118Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
119were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
120into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
121names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
122Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
123releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000124
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200125Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000126 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200127 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
128 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000129
130
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000131Directory Hierarchy:
132====================
133
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500134/arch Architecture specific files
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900135 /arc Files generic to ARC architecture
136 /cpu CPU specific files
137 /arc700 Files specific to ARC 700 CPUs
138 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500139 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
140 /cpu CPU specific files
141 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
142 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000143 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200144 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
145 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500146 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
147 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500148 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500149 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
150 /lib Architecture specific library files
151 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
152 /cpu CPU specific files
153 /lib Architecture specific library files
154 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
155 /cpu CPU specific files
156 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500157 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
158 /cpu CPU specific files
159 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
160 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
161 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
162 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
163 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
164 /lib Architecture specific library files
165 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
166 /cpu CPU specific files
167 /lib Architecture specific library files
168 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
169 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200170 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900171 /mips64 Files specific to MIPS64 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500172 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000173 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
174 /cpu CPU specific files
175 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
176 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500177 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
178 /cpu CPU specific files
179 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400180 /openrisc Files generic to OpenRISC architecture
181 /cpu CPU specific files
182 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200183 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500184 /cpu CPU specific files
185 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
186 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
187 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
188 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500189 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
190 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
191 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
192 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
193 /lib Architecture specific library files
194 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
195 /cpu CPU specific files
196 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
197 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
198 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
199 /lib Architecture specific library files
200 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
201 /cpu CPU specific files
202 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
203 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
204 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400205 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
206 /cpu CPU specific files
207 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500208/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
209/board Board dependent files
210/common Misc architecture independent functions
211/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
212/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
213/drivers Commonly used device drivers
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400214/dts Contains Makefile for building internal U-Boot fdt.
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500215/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
216/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
217/include Header Files
218/lib Files generic to all architectures
219 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
220 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
221 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
222/net Networking code
223/post Power On Self Test
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400224/spl Secondary Program Loader framework
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500225/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000226
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000227Software Configuration:
228=======================
229
230Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
231rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
232
233There are two classes of configuration variables:
234
235* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
236 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
237 "CONFIG_".
238
239* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
240 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
241 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200242 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000243
244Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
245identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
246do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
247links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
248as an example here.
249
250
251Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
252---------------------------------------------------
253
254For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200255configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_defconfig".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000256
257Example: For a TQM823L module type:
258
259 cd u-boot
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200260 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000261
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200262For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200263e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_defconfig". And also configure the cogent
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000264directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
265
266
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600267Sandbox Environment:
268--------------------
269
270U-Boot can be built natively to run on a Linux host using the 'sandbox'
271board. This allows feature development which is not board- or architecture-
272specific to be undertaken on a native platform. The sandbox is also used to
273run some of U-Boot's tests.
274
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki6b1978f2014-08-31 21:19:43 +0530275See board/sandbox/README.sandbox for more details.
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600276
277
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000278Configuration Options:
279----------------------
280
281Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
282such information is kept in a configuration file
283"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
284
285Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
286"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
287
288
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000289Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
290kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
291build a config tool - later.
292
293
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000294The following options need to be configured:
295
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500296- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000297
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500298- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200299
300- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100301 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000302
303- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
304 Define exactly one of
305 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
306--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
307 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
308 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
309
310- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
311 Define exactly one of
312 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
313
314- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
315 Define one or more of
316 CONFIG_CMA302
317
318- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
319 Define one or more of
320 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200321 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000322 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
323
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530324- Marvell Family Member
325 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
326 multiple fs option at one time
327 for marvell soc family
328
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000329- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000330 Define exactly one of
331 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000332
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200333- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000334 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
335 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000336 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
337 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000338 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
339 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000340
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000341- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200342 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
343 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000344 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000345 See doc/README.MPC866
346
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200347 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000348
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000349 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
350 of relying on the correctness of the configured
351 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
352 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
353 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200354 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000355
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100356 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
357
358 Define this option if you want to enable the
359 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
360
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600361- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sunffd06e02012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000362 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
363
364 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
365 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
366 compliance, among other possible reasons.
367
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600368 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
369
370 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
371 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
372 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
373
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500374 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
375
376 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
377 tree nodes for the given platform.
378
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000379 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
380
381 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
382 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
383 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
384 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
385 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
386 purpose.
387
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000388 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
389
390 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
391 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
392 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
393
394 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
395 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
396
397 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
398 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
399
400 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
401 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
402 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
403 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
404
405 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
406 this erratum.
407
Prabhakar Kushwaha74fa22e2013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530408 CONFIG_A003399_NOR_WORKAROUND
409 Enables a workaround for IFC erratum A003399. It is only
410 requred during NOR boot.
411
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000412 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
413
414 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
415 according to the A004510 workaround.
416
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530417 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_DDR_ADDR
418 This value denotes start offset of DDR memory which is
419 connected exclusively to the DSP cores.
420
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530421 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M2_RAM_ADDR
422 This value denotes start offset of M2 memory
423 which is directly connected to the DSP core.
424
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530425 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M3_RAM_ADDR
426 This value denotes start offset of M3 memory which is directly
427 connected to the DSP core.
428
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530429 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT
430 This value denotes start offset of DSP CCSR space.
431
Priyanka Jainb1359912013-12-17 14:25:52 +0530432 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SINGLE_SOURCE_CLK
433 Single Source Clock is clocking mode present in some of FSL SoC's.
434 In this mode, a single differential clock is used to supply
435 clocks to the sysclock, ddrclock and usbclock.
436
Aneesh Bansalfb4a2402014-03-18 23:40:26 +0530437 CONFIG_SYS_CPC_REINIT_F
438 This CONFIG is defined when the CPC is configured as SRAM at the
439 time of U-boot entry and is required to be re-initialized.
440
Tang Yuantianaade2002014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800441 CONFIG_DEEP_SLEEP
442 Inidcates this SoC supports deep sleep feature. If deep sleep is
443 supported, core will start to execute uboot when wakes up.
444
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000445- Generic CPU options:
York Sun2a1680e2014-05-02 17:28:04 -0700446 CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_GLOBAL_DATA
447 Defines global data is initialized in generic board board_init_f().
448 If this macro is defined, global data is created and cleared in
449 generic board board_init_f(). Without this macro, architecture/board
450 should initialize global data before calling board_init_f().
451
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000452 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
453
454 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
455 values is arch specific.
456
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700457 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR
458 Freescale DDR driver in use. This type of DDR controller is
459 found in mpc83xx, mpc85xx, mpc86xx as well as some ARM core
460 SoCs.
461
462 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_ADDR
463 Freescale DDR memory-mapped register base.
464
465 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_EMU
466 Specify emulator support for DDR. Some DDR features such as
467 deskew training are not available.
468
469 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN1
470 Freescale DDR1 controller.
471
472 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN2
473 Freescale DDR2 controller.
474
475 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN3
476 Freescale DDR3 controller.
477
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700478 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN4
479 Freescale DDR4 controller.
480
York Sun9ac4ffb2013-09-30 14:20:51 -0700481 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_ARM_GEN3
482 Freescale DDR3 controller for ARM-based SoCs.
483
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700484 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR1
485 Board config to use DDR1. It can be enabled for SoCs with
486 Freescale DDR1 or DDR2 controllers, depending on the board
487 implemetation.
488
489 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR2
490 Board config to use DDR2. It can be eanbeld for SoCs with
491 Freescale DDR2 or DDR3 controllers, depending on the board
492 implementation.
493
494 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3
495 Board config to use DDR3. It can be enabled for SoCs with
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700496 Freescale DDR3 or DDR3L controllers.
497
498 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3L
499 Board config to use DDR3L. It can be enabled for SoCs with
500 DDR3L controllers.
501
502 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR4
503 Board config to use DDR4. It can be enabled for SoCs with
504 DDR4 controllers.
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700505
Prabhakar Kushwaha1b4175d2014-01-18 12:28:30 +0530506 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_BE
507 Defines the IFC controller register space as Big Endian
508
509 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_LE
510 Defines the IFC controller register space as Little Endian
511
Prabhakar Kushwaha690e4252014-01-13 11:28:04 +0530512 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_PBI
513 It enables addition of RCW (Power on reset configuration) in built image.
514 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
515
516 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_RCW
517 It adds PBI(pre-boot instructions) commands in u-boot build image.
518 PBI commands can be used to configure SoC before it starts the execution.
519 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
520
Prabhakar Kushwaha89ad7be2014-04-08 19:13:34 +0530521 CONFIG_SPL_FSL_PBL
522 It adds a target to create boot binary having SPL binary in PBI format
523 concatenated with u-boot binary.
524
York Sun4e5b1bd2014-02-10 13:59:42 -0800525 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_BE
526 Defines the DDR controller register space as Big Endian
527
528 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_LE
529 Defines the DDR controller register space as Little Endian
530
York Sun6b9e3092014-02-10 13:59:43 -0800531 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_SDRAM_BASE_PHY
532 Physical address from the view of DDR controllers. It is the
533 same as CONFIG_SYS_DDR_SDRAM_BASE for all Power SoCs. But
534 it could be different for ARM SoCs.
535
York Sun6b1e1252014-02-10 13:59:44 -0800536 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_INTLV_256B
537 DDR controller interleaving on 256-byte. This is a special
538 interleaving mode, handled by Dickens for Freescale layerscape
539 SoCs with ARM core.
540
York Sun1d71efb2014-08-01 15:51:00 -0700541 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_MAIN_NUM_CTRLS
542 Number of controllers used as main memory.
543
544 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_OTHER_DDR_NUM_CTRLS
545 Number of controllers used for other than main memory.
546
Ruchika Gupta028dbb82014-09-09 11:50:31 +0530547 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_BE
548 Defines the SEC controller register space as Big Endian
549
550 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_LE
551 Defines the SEC controller register space as Little Endian
552
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100553- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200554 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100555
556 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
557 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
558 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
559
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200560 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200561
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100562 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
563 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200564 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100565 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200566
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200567- MIPS CPU options:
568 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
569
570 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
571 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
572 relocation.
573
574 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
575
576 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
577 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
578 Possible values are:
579 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
580 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
581 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
582 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
583 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
584 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
585 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
586 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
587
588 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
589
590 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
591 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
592
593 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
594
595 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
596 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
597 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
598
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000599- ARM options:
600 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
601
602 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
603 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
604
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000605 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
606
607 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
608 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
609 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
610 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
611 GCC.
612
Stephen Warrenc5d47522013-03-04 13:29:40 +0000613 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_716044
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000614 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_742230
615 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_743622
616 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_751472
Nitin Gargf71cbfe2014-04-02 08:55:01 -0500617 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_794072
Nitin Gargb7588e32014-04-02 08:55:02 -0500618 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_761320
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000619
620 If set, the workarounds for these ARM errata are applied early
621 during U-Boot startup. Note that these options force the
622 workarounds to be applied; no CPU-type/version detection
623 exists, unlike the similar options in the Linux kernel. Do not
624 set these options unless they apply!
625
Stephen Warren795659d2013-03-27 17:06:41 +0000626- CPU timer options:
627 CONFIG_SYS_HZ
628
629 The frequency of the timer returned by get_timer().
630 get_timer() must operate in milliseconds and this CONFIG
631 option must be set to 1000.
632
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000633- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000634 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
635
636 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
637 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
638 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
639 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
640 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
641 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
642 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000643 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100644 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000645 default environment.
646
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000647 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
648
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200649 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000650 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
651 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
652
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400653 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200654
655 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400656 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
657 concepts).
658
659 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
660 * New libfdt-based support
661 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500662 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400663
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200664 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
665 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
666 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
667 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200668 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600669 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200670
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200671 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
672 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500673
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600674 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
675
676 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
677 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000678
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500679 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
680
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200681 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500682 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
683
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200684 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
685
686 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
687 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
688 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
689 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
690 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
691 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
692
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000693 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
694
695 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
696 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
697 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
698 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
699 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
700 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
701 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
702
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100703- vxWorks boot parameters:
704
705 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
706 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
707 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
708
709 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
710 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
711 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
712 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
713
714 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
715
716 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
717
718 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
719 the defaults discussed just above.
720
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000721- Cache Configuration:
722 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
723 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
724 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
725
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000726- Cache Configuration for ARM:
727 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
728 controller
729 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
730 controller register space
731
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000732- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200733 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000734
735 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
736
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200737 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000738
739 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
740
741 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
742
743 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
744 the clock speed of the UARTs.
745
746 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
747
748 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
749 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
750 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
751
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000752 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
753
754 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
755 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
756 this variable to initialize the extra register.
757
758 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
759
760 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
761 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
762 variable to flush the UART at init time.
763
Karicheri, Muralidharand57dee52014-04-09 15:38:46 -0400764 CONFIG_SERIAL_HW_FLOW_CONTROL
765
766 Define this variable to enable hw flow control in serial driver.
767 Current user of this option is drivers/serial/nsl16550.c driver
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000768
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000769- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000770 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
771 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
772 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
773 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000774
775 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
776 port routines must be defined elsewhere
777 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
778
779 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
780 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000781 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000782 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
783 (default big endian)
784 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
785 rectangle fill
786 (cf. smiLynxEM)
787 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
788 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
789 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
790 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000791 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
792 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000793 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
794 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000795 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000796 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
797 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
798 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
799 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
800 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
801 (i.e. i8042_getc)
802 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
803 (requires blink timer
804 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200805 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000806 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
807 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500808 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000809 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
810 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000811 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
812 linux_logo.h for logo.
813 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000814 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200815 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000816 the logo
817
Pali Rohár33a35bb2012-10-19 13:30:09 +0000818 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE_ANSI is defined, console will support
819 a limited number of ANSI escape sequences (cursor control,
820 erase functions and limited graphics rendition control).
821
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000822 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
823 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
824 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000825
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000826 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
827 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
828 the "silent" environment variable. See
829 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000830
Heiko Schocher45ae2542013-10-22 11:06:06 +0200831 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BG_COL: define the backgroundcolor, default
832 is 0x00.
833 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_FG_COL: define the foregroundcolor, default
834 is 0xa0.
835
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000836- Console Baudrate:
837 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
838 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200839 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
840 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000841
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100842- Console Rx buffer length
843 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
844 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100845 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100846 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
847 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
848 the SMC.
849
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000850- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200851 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
852 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
853 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
854 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
855 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
856 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
857 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200858 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200859 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000860
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200861 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
862 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000863
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000864- Safe printf() functions
865 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
866 the printf() functions. These are defined in
867 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
868 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
869 If this option is not given then these functions will
870 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
871 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
872
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000873- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
874 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
875 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
Joe Hershberger93d72122012-08-17 10:53:12 +0000876 set to -2 to autoboot with no delay and not check for abort
877 (even when CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK is defined).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000878
879 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
880 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
881 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
882 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
883 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
884 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
885 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
886 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
887 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
888 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
889 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
890 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
891
892- Autoboot Command:
893 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
894 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
895 define a command string that is automatically executed
896 when no character is read on the console interface
897 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
898
899 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000900 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
901 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
902 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000903
904 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000905 The value of these goes into the environment as
906 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
907 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200908 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000909
Heiko Schochereda0ba32013-11-04 14:04:59 +0100910- Bootcount:
911 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
912 Implements a mechanism for detecting a repeating reboot
913 cycle, see:
914 http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
915
916 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ENV
917 If no softreset save registers are found on the hardware
918 "bootcount" is stored in the environment. To prevent a
919 saveenv on all reboots, the environment variable
920 "upgrade_available" is used. If "upgrade_available" is
921 0, "bootcount" is always 0, if "upgrade_available" is
922 1 "bootcount" is incremented in the environment.
923 So the Userspace Applikation must set the "upgrade_available"
924 and "bootcount" variable to 0, if a boot was successfully.
925
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000926- Pre-Boot Commands:
927 CONFIG_PREBOOT
928
929 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
930 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
931 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
932 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
933 entering interactive mode.
934
935 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
936 automatically generated or modified. For an example
937 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
938 modified when the user holds down a certain
939 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
940 booting the systems
941
942- Serial Download Echo Mode:
943 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
944 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
945 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
946 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
947 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
948 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
949 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
950
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500951- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000952 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
953 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200954 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000955
956- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500957 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
958 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +0000959 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
960 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500961 and augmenting with additional #define's
962 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000963
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500964 The default command configuration includes all commands
965 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000966
Marek Vasutb401b732014-03-05 19:58:39 +0100967 CONFIG_CMD_AES AES 128 CBC encrypt/decrypt
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500968 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500969 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
970 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
971 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
972 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
973 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
Tom Rinid2b2ffe2014-08-14 06:42:36 -0400974 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTI * ARM64 Linux kernel Image support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500975 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
Michal Simek08d0d6f2013-11-21 13:39:02 -0800976 CONFIG_CMD_CLK * clock command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500977 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500978 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500979 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
980 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
981 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600982 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
983 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
984 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
985 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500986 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
987 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500988 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500989 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
990 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Joe Hershberger5e2b3e02012-12-11 22:16:25 -0600991 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_CALLBACK * display details about env callbacks
Joe Hershbergerfffad712012-12-11 22:16:33 -0600992 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_FLAGS * display details about env flags
Andrew Ruder88733e22013-10-22 19:07:34 -0500993 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_EXISTS * check existence of env variable
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500994 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000995 CONFIG_CMD_EXT2 * ext2 command support
996 CONFIG_CMD_EXT4 * ext4 command support
Stephen Warren16f4d932014-01-24 20:46:37 -0700997 CONFIG_CMD_FS_GENERIC * filesystem commands (e.g. load, ls)
998 that work for multiple fs types
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500999 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001000 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +00001001 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001002 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
1003 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001004 CONFIG_CMD_FUSE * Device fuse support
Anton Staaf53fdc7e2012-12-05 14:46:29 +00001005 CONFIG_CMD_GETTIME * Get time since boot
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -05001006 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +00001007 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00001008 CONFIG_CMD_HASH * calculate hash / digest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001009 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
1010 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
1011 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
1012 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
Vipin Kumar8fdf1e02012-12-16 22:32:48 +00001013 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all images found in NOR flash
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001014 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS_NAND * List all images found in NAND flash
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001015 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -06001016 CONFIG_CMD_IOTRACE * I/O tracing for debugging
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -05001017 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Joe Hershbergerc167cc02012-10-03 11:15:51 +00001018 CONFIG_CMD_INI * import data from an ini file into the env
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001019 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
1020 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
1021 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
1022 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001023 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO * ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001024 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
1025 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001026 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
1027 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001028 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM * print md5 message digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -04001029 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Simon Glass15a33e42012-11-30 13:01:20 +00001030 CONFIG_CMD_MEMINFO * Display detailed memory information
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001031 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
Wolfgang Denka2681702013-03-08 10:51:32 +00001032 loop, loopw
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001033 CONFIG_CMD_MEMTEST * mtest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001034 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
1035 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
1036 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +01001037 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001038 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
1039 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001040 CONFIG_CMD_NFS NFS support
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001041 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001042 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001043 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
1044 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
1045 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
1046 host
1047 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
Kenneth Watersff048ea2012-12-05 14:46:30 +00001048 CONFIG_CMD_READ * Read raw data from partition
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001049 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
1050 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
Simon Glassd3049312012-12-26 09:53:36 +00001051 CONFIG_CMD_SANDBOX * sb command to access sandbox features
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001052 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
1053 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
1054 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
1055 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
1056 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
1057 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07001058 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001059 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM * print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -04001060 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Bob Liu7d861d92013-02-05 19:05:41 +08001061 CONFIG_CMD_SOFTSWITCH * Soft switch setting command for BF60x
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02001062 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001063 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +00001064 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00001065 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Joe Hershbergerda83bcd2012-10-03 12:14:57 +00001066 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time (ARM specific)
1067 CONFIG_CMD_TIMER * access to the system tick timer
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001068 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001069 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +00001070 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001071 CONFIG_CMD_XIMG Load part of Multi Image
Przemyslaw Marczak89c82302014-04-02 10:20:05 +02001072 CONFIG_CMD_UUID * Generate random UUID or GUID string
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001073
1074 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
1075 support you can write:
1076
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001077 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
1078 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001079
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -04001080 Other Commands:
1081 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001082
1083 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001084 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001085 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
1086 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
1087 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
1088 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
1089 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
1090 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001091
1092
1093 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
1094
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001095- Regular expression support:
1096 CONFIG_REGEX
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001097 If this variable is defined, U-Boot is linked against
1098 the SLRE (Super Light Regular Expression) library,
1099 which adds regex support to some commands, as for
1100 example "env grep" and "setexpr".
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001101
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001102- Device tree:
1103 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
1104 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
1105 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
1106 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
1107 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
1108 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
1109
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001110 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
1111 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +00001112
1113 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
1114 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
1115 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
1116 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
1117 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
1118 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001119
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001120 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
1121 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
1122 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
1123 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
1124
1125 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
1126
1127 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
1128 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
1129 still use the individual files if you need something more
1130 exotic.
1131
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001132- Watchdog:
1133 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
1134 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +00001135 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
1136 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
1137 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
1138 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
1139 available, then no further board specific code should
1140 be needed to use it.
1141
1142 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
1143 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
1144 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
1145 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001146
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001147- U-Boot Version:
1148 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
1149 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
1150 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
1151 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e512012-08-13 15:01:14 +02001152 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
1153 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001154
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001155- Real-Time Clock:
1156
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001157 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001158 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
1159 following options:
1160
1161 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
1162 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +00001163 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001164 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +00001165 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001166 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +00001167 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
Markus Niebel412921d2014-07-21 11:06:16 +02001168 CONFIG_RTC_DS1339 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1339 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +00001169 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +01001170 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +00001171 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001172 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +02001173 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
1174 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001175
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001176 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1177 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1178
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001179- GPIO Support:
1180 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001181
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +00001182 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
1183 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
1184 pins supported by a particular chip.
1185
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001186 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1187 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1188
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -06001189- I/O tracing:
1190 When CONFIG_IO_TRACE is selected, U-Boot intercepts all I/O
1191 accesses and can checksum them or write a list of them out
1192 to memory. See the 'iotrace' command for details. This is
1193 useful for testing device drivers since it can confirm that
1194 the driver behaves the same way before and after a code
1195 change. Currently this is supported on sandbox and arm. To
1196 add support for your architecture, add '#include <iotrace.h>'
1197 to the bottom of arch/<arch>/include/asm/io.h and test.
1198
1199 Example output from the 'iotrace stats' command is below.
1200 Note that if the trace buffer is exhausted, the checksum will
1201 still continue to operate.
1202
1203 iotrace is enabled
1204 Start: 10000000 (buffer start address)
1205 Size: 00010000 (buffer size)
1206 Offset: 00000120 (current buffer offset)
1207 Output: 10000120 (start + offset)
1208 Count: 00000018 (number of trace records)
1209 CRC32: 9526fb66 (CRC32 of all trace records)
1210
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001211- Timestamp Support:
1212
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001213 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
1214 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
1215 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001216 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001217
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001218- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
1219 Zero or more of the following:
1220 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
1221 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
1222 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
1223 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
1224 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
1225 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
1226 disk/part_efi.c
1227 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001228
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01001229 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
1230 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001231 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001232
1233- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001234 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
1235 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001236
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001237 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
1238 be performed by calling the function
1239 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1240 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001241
1242- ATAPI Support:
1243 CONFIG_ATAPI
1244
1245 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1246
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001247- LBA48 Support
1248 CONFIG_LBA48
1249
1250 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001251 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001252 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1253 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1254
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001255 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001256 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1257 Default is 32bit.
1258
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001259- SCSI Support:
1260 At the moment only there is only support for the
1261 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1262 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1263
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001264 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1265 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1266 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001267 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1268 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001269 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001270
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001271 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
1272 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
Stefan Reinauer447c0312012-10-29 05:23:48 +00001273
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001274- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001275 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001276 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1277
1278 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1279 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1280 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1281 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1282
1283 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1284 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1285 example with the "sspi" command.
1286
1287 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1288 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1289 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001290
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001291 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001292 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001293
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001294 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1295 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001296 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001297 write routine for first time initialisation.
1298
1299 CONFIG_TULIP
1300 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1301 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1302 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1303
1304 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1305 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1306
1307 CONFIG_NS8382X
1308 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1309
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001310- NETWORK Support (other):
1311
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001312 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1313 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1314
1315 CONFIG_RMII
1316 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1317
1318 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1319 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1320 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1321
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001322 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1323 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1324
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001325 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001326 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1327
1328 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1329 Define this to hold the physical address
1330 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1331
1332 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1333 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1334
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001335 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001336 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1337
1338 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1339 Define this to hold the physical address
1340 of the device (I/O space)
1341
1342 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1343 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1344
1345 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1346 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1347 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1348
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001349 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1350 Support for davinci emac
1351
1352 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1353 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1354
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001355 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1356 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1357
1358 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1359 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1360 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1361 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1362 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1363 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1364 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1365 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1366
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001367 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001368 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1369
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001370 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001371 Define this to hold the physical address
1372 of the device (I/O space)
1373
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001374 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001375 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1376
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001377 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001378 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1379 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001380 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001381
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001382 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1383 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1384
1385 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1386 Define the number of ports to be used
1387
1388 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1389 Define the ETH PHY's address
1390
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001391 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1392 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1393
Heiko Schocherb2f97cf2014-07-18 06:07:19 +02001394- PWM Support:
1395 CONFIG_PWM_IMX
1396 Support for PWM modul on the imx6.
1397
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001398- TPM Support:
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001399 CONFIG_TPM
1400 Support TPM devices.
1401
Tom Wai-Hong Tam1b393db2013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001402 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C
1403 Support for i2c bus TPM devices. Only one device
1404 per system is supported at this time.
1405
1406 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BUS_NUMBER
1407 Define the the i2c bus number for the TPM device
1408
1409 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_SLAVE_ADDRESS
1410 Define the TPM's address on the i2c bus
1411
1412 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BURST_LIMITATION
1413 Define the burst count bytes upper limit
1414
Dirk Eibachc01939c2013-06-26 15:55:15 +02001415 CONFIG_TPM_ATMEL_TWI
1416 Support for Atmel TWI TPM device. Requires I2C support.
1417
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001418 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_LPC
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001419 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1420 per system is supported at this time.
1421
1422 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1423 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1424 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1425 0xfed40000.
1426
Reinhard Pfaube6c1522013-06-26 15:55:13 +02001427 CONFIG_CMD_TPM
1428 Add tpm monitor functions.
1429 Requires CONFIG_TPM. If CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS is set, also
1430 provides monitor access to authorized functions.
1431
1432 CONFIG_TPM
1433 Define this to enable the TPM support library which provides
1434 functional interfaces to some TPM commands.
1435 Requires support for a TPM device.
1436
1437 CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS
1438 Define this to enable authorized functions in the TPM library.
1439 Requires CONFIG_TPM and CONFIG_SHA1.
1440
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001441- USB Support:
1442 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001443 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001444 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1445 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001446 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001447 storage devices.
1448 Note:
1449 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1450 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001451 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1452 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1453 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001454 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1455 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001456 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1457 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1458 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001459 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1460 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001461 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001462 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1463 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001464
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001465 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1466 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1467
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001468- USB Device:
1469 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1470 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1471 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001472 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001473 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1474 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001475 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001476 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1477 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1478 a Linux host by
1479 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1480 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1481 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1482 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001483
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001484 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1485 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001486
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001487 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1488 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1489 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001490
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301491 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1492 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1493 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1494 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1495 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1496 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1497 speed.
1498
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001499 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001500 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1501 be set to usbtty.
1502
1503 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001504 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001505 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001506 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001507
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001508 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001509 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001510 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001511
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001512 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001513 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001514 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001515 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1516 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1517 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1518
1519 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1520 Define this string as the name of your company for
1521 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001522
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001523 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1524 Define this string as the name of your product
1525 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1526
1527 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1528 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1529 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1530 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1531 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001532
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001533 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1534 Define this as the unique Product ID
1535 for your device
1536 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001537
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001538- ULPI Layer Support:
1539 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1540 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1541 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1542 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1543 viewport is supported.
1544 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1545 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stach6d365ea2012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001546 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1547 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1548 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001549
1550- MMC Support:
1551 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1552 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1553 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1554 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001555 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1556 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001557
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001558 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1559 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1560
1561 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1562 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1563
1564 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1565 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1566
Pierre Aubert1fd93c62014-04-24 10:30:08 +02001567 CONFIG_GENERIC_MMC
1568 Enable the generic MMC driver
1569
1570 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_BOOT
1571 Enable some additional features of the eMMC boot partitions.
1572
1573 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_RPMB
1574 Enable the commands for reading, writing and programming the
1575 key for the Replay Protection Memory Block partition in eMMC.
1576
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001577- USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) class support:
1578 CONFIG_DFU_FUNCTION
1579 This enables the USB portion of the DFU USB class
1580
1581 CONFIG_CMD_DFU
1582 This enables the command "dfu" which is used to have
1583 U-Boot create a DFU class device via USB. This command
1584 requires that the "dfu_alt_info" environment variable be
1585 set and define the alt settings to expose to the host.
1586
1587 CONFIG_DFU_MMC
1588 This enables support for exposing (e)MMC devices via DFU.
1589
Pantelis Antoniouc6631762013-03-14 05:32:52 +00001590 CONFIG_DFU_NAND
1591 This enables support for exposing NAND devices via DFU.
1592
Afzal Mohammeda9479f02013-09-18 01:15:24 +05301593 CONFIG_DFU_RAM
1594 This enables support for exposing RAM via DFU.
1595 Note: DFU spec refer to non-volatile memory usage, but
1596 allow usages beyond the scope of spec - here RAM usage,
1597 one that would help mostly the developer.
1598
Heiko Schochere7e75c72013-06-12 06:05:51 +02001599 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE
1600 Dfu transfer uses a buffer before writing data to the
1601 raw storage device. Make the size (in bytes) of this buffer
1602 configurable. The size of this buffer is also configurable
1603 through the "dfu_bufsiz" environment variable.
1604
Pantelis Antoniouea2453d2013-03-14 05:32:48 +00001605 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE
1606 When updating files rather than the raw storage device,
1607 we use a static buffer to copy the file into and then write
1608 the buffer once we've been given the whole file. Define
1609 this to the maximum filesize (in bytes) for the buffer.
1610 Default is 4 MiB if undefined.
1611
Heiko Schocher001a8312014-03-18 08:09:56 +01001612 DFU_DEFAULT_POLL_TIMEOUT
1613 Poll timeout [ms], is the timeout a device can send to the
1614 host. The host must wait for this timeout before sending
1615 a subsequent DFU_GET_STATUS request to the device.
1616
1617 DFU_MANIFEST_POLL_TIMEOUT
1618 Poll timeout [ms], which the device sends to the host when
1619 entering dfuMANIFEST state. Host waits this timeout, before
1620 sending again an USB request to the device.
1621
Sebastian Siewior3aab70a2014-05-05 15:08:10 -05001622- USB Device Android Fastboot support:
1623 CONFIG_CMD_FASTBOOT
1624 This enables the command "fastboot" which enables the Android
1625 fastboot mode for the platform's USB device. Fastboot is a USB
1626 protocol for downloading images, flashing and device control
1627 used on Android devices.
1628 See doc/README.android-fastboot for more information.
1629
1630 CONFIG_ANDROID_BOOT_IMAGE
1631 This enables support for booting images which use the Android
1632 image format header.
1633
1634 CONFIG_USB_FASTBOOT_BUF_ADDR
1635 The fastboot protocol requires a large memory buffer for
1636 downloads. Define this to the starting RAM address to use for
1637 downloaded images.
1638
1639 CONFIG_USB_FASTBOOT_BUF_SIZE
1640 The fastboot protocol requires a large memory buffer for
1641 downloads. This buffer should be as large as possible for a
1642 platform. Define this to the size available RAM for fastboot.
1643
Steve Raed1b5ed02014-08-26 11:47:28 -07001644 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH
1645 The fastboot protocol includes a "flash" command for writing
1646 the downloaded image to a non-volatile storage device. Define
1647 this to enable the "fastboot flash" command.
1648
1649 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH_MMC_DEV
1650 The fastboot "flash" command requires additional information
1651 regarding the non-volatile storage device. Define this to
1652 the eMMC device that fastboot should use to store the image.
1653
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001654- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1655 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1656 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1657 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1658
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001659 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1660 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001661 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1662
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001663 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001664 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1665 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1666
1667 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001668 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001669 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1670 have not defined a custom partition
1671
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001672- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1673 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001674
1675 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1676 file in FAT formatted partition.
1677
1678 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1679 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001680
Gabe Black84cd9322012-10-12 14:26:11 +00001681CBFS (Coreboot Filesystem) support
1682 CONFIG_CMD_CBFS
1683
1684 Define this to enable support for reading from a Coreboot
1685 filesystem. Available commands are cbfsinit, cbfsinfo, cbfsls
1686 and cbfsload.
1687
Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu4f0d1a22014-05-26 19:18:37 +05301688- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem cluster size:
1689 CONFIG_FS_FAT_MAX_CLUSTSIZE
1690
1691 Define the max cluster size for fat operations else
1692 a default value of 65536 will be defined.
1693
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001694- Keyboard Support:
1695 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1696
1697 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1698 support
1699
1700 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1701 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1702 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1703 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1704 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1705
Hung-ying Tyan713cb682013-05-15 18:27:32 +08001706 CONFIG_CROS_EC_KEYB
1707 Enables a Chrome OS keyboard using the CROS_EC interface.
1708 This uses CROS_EC to communicate with a second microcontroller
1709 which provides key scans on request.
1710
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001711- Video support:
1712 CONFIG_VIDEO
1713
1714 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1715 video).
1716
1717 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1718
1719 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1720
1721 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001722 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001723 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1724 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1725 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001726
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001727 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001728 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001729 are possible:
1730 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001731 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001732
1733 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1734 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1735 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1736 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1737 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1738 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1739 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001740 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1741
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001742 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001743 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001744
1745
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001746 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001747 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001748 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1749 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1750
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001751 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001752 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001753 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1754 support, and should also define these other macros:
1755
1756 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1757 CONFIG_VIDEO
1758 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1759 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1760 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1761 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1762 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1763 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1764
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001765 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1766 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1767 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1768 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001769
Simon Glass058d59b2012-12-03 13:59:47 +00001770 CONFIG_VIDEO_VGA
1771
1772 Enable the VGA video / BIOS for x86. The alternative if you
1773 are using coreboot is to use the coreboot frame buffer
1774 driver.
1775
1776
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001777- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001778 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001779
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001780 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1781 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1782 defined in your board-specific files.
1783 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001784
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001785- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1786
1787 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1788 display); also select one of the supported displays
1789 by defining one of these:
1790
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001791 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1792
1793 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1794
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001795 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001796
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001797 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001798
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001799 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001800
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001801 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1802 Active, color, single scan.
1803
1804 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1805
1806 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001807 Active, color, single scan.
1808
1809 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1810
1811 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1812 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1813
1814 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1815
1816 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1817 Active, color, single scan.
1818
1819 CONFIG_HLD1045
1820
1821 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1822 Active, color, single scan.
1823
1824 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1825
1826 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1827 or
1828 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1829 or
1830 Hitachi SP14Q002
1831
1832 320x240. Black & white.
1833
1834 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001835 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001836
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001837 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1838
1839 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (tyically 4KB). If this is
1840 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1841 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1842 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1843 a per-section basis.
1844
Simon Glass0d89efe2012-10-17 13:24:59 +00001845 CONFIG_CONSOLE_SCROLL_LINES
1846
1847 When the console need to be scrolled, this is the number of
1848 lines to scroll by. It defaults to 1. Increasing this makes
1849 the console jump but can help speed up operation when scrolling
1850 is slow.
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001851
Tom Wai-Hong Tam45d7f522012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001852 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1853
1854 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1855
Tom Wai-Hong Tam735987c2012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001856 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1857
1858 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1859 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1860
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001861- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001862
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001863 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1864 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1865 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001866 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001867 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1868 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1869 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1870 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001871
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001872 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1873
1874 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1875 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
Tom Rini1551df32014-02-25 10:27:01 -05001876 (see README.displaying-bmps).
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001877 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1878 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1879 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1880 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1881 there is no need to set this option.
1882
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001883 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1884
1885 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1886 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1887 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1888 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1889 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1890 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1891
1892 Example:
1893 setenv splashpos m,m
1894 => image at center of screen
1895
1896 setenv splashpos 30,20
1897 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1898
1899 setenv splashpos -10,m
1900 => vertically centered image
1901 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1902
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001903- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1904
1905 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1906 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1907 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1908
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001909- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1910
1911 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1912 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1913 bmp command.
1914
Lei Wenf2b96df2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00001915- Do compresssing for memory range:
1916 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
1917
1918 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
1919 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
1920
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001921- Compression support:
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001922 CONFIG_GZIP
1923
1924 Enabled by default to support gzip compressed images.
1925
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001926 CONFIG_BZIP2
1927
1928 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1929 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1930 compressed images are supported.
1931
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001932 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001933 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001934 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001935
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001936 CONFIG_LZMA
1937
1938 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1939 images is included.
1940
1941 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1942 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1943 formula:
1944
1945 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1946
1947 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1948 and Literal pos bits.
1949
1950 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1951 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1952 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1953 a very small buffer.
1954
1955 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1956 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001957 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001958
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001959 CONFIG_LZO
1960
1961 If this option is set, support for LZO compressed images
1962 is included.
1963
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001964- MII/PHY support:
1965 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1966
1967 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1968
1969 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1970
1971 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1972
1973 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1974
1975 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001976 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001977
1978 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1979
1980 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1981 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1982 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1983 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1984
1985 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1986
1987 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1988 command issued before MII status register can be read
1989
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001990- Ethernet address:
1991 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001992 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001993 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1994 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001995 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1996 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001997
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001998 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1999 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002000 is not determined automatically.
2001
2002- IP address:
2003 CONFIG_IPADDR
2004
2005 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002006 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002007 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002008 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002009
2010- Server IP address:
2011 CONFIG_SERVERIP
2012
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002013 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002014 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002015 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002016
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04002017 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
2018
2019 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
2020 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
2021
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002022- Gateway IP address:
2023 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
2024
2025 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
2026 default router where packets to other networks are
2027 sent to.
2028 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
2029
2030- Subnet mask:
2031 CONFIG_NETMASK
2032
2033 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
2034 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
2035 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
2036 forwarded through a router.
2037 (Environment variable "netmask")
2038
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05002039- Multicast TFTP Mode:
2040 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
2041
2042 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
2043 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002044 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05002045 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
2046 multicast group.
2047
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002048- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
2049 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
2050
2051 If you have many targets in a network that try to
2052 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
2053 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
2054 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
2055 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
2056 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
2057 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
2058 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02002059 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002060
2061 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
2062 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
2063 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
2064 4th and following
2065 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
2066
Thierry Reding92ac8ac2014-08-19 10:21:24 +02002067 CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE
2068
2069 BOOTP packets are uniquely identified using a 32-bit ID. The
2070 server will copy the ID from client requests to responses and
2071 U-Boot will use this to determine if it is the destination of
2072 an incoming response. Some servers will check that addresses
2073 aren't in use before handing them out (usually using an ARP
2074 ping) and therefore take up to a few hundred milliseconds to
2075 respond. Network congestion may also influence the time it
2076 takes for a response to make it back to the client. If that
2077 time is too long, U-Boot will retransmit requests. In order
2078 to allow earlier responses to still be accepted after these
2079 retransmissions, U-Boot's BOOTP client keeps a small cache of
2080 IDs. The CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE controls the size of this
2081 cache. The default is to keep IDs for up to four outstanding
2082 requests. Increasing this will allow U-Boot to accept offers
2083 from a BOOTP client in networks with unusually high latency.
2084
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002085- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002086 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
2087 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002088
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002089 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
2090 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
2091 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
2092 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
2093 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
2094 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
2095 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
2096 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
2097 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
2098 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
2099 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
2100 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00002101 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002102
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04002103 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
2104 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002105
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00002106 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
2107 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
2108 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
2109 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
2110 is not available.
2111
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002112 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
2113 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
2114 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
2115 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
2116 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
2117 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
2118 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002119 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002120
2121 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
2122 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
2123 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04002124 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002125 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
2126 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002127
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11002128 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
2129
2130 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
2131 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
2132 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
2133 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
2134 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
2135 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
2136 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
2137 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
2138 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
2139 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
2140 this delay.
2141
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00002142 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
2143 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
2144 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
2145 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
2146 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
2147
2148 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
2149
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002150 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00002151 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002152
2153 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
2154
2155 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
2156
2157 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
2158 of the device.
2159
2160 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
2161
2162 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
2163 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002164 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002165
2166 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
2167
2168 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
2169 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
2170
2171 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
2172
2173 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
2174
2175 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
2176
2177 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
2178
2179 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
2180
2181 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
2182
2183 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
2184
2185 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
2186 device in .1 of milliwatts.
2187
2188 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
2189
2190 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
2191
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002192- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
2193
2194 Several configurations allow to display the current
2195 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
2196 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
2197 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
2198 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
2199 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
2200 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
2201 feature in U-Boot.
2202
Igor Grinberg1df7bbb2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02002203 Additional options:
2204
2205 CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2206 The status LED can be connected to a GPIO pin.
2207 In such cases, the gpio_led driver can be used as a
2208 status LED backend implementation. Define CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2209 to include the gpio_led driver in the U-Boot binary.
2210
Igor Grinberg9dfdcdf2013-11-08 01:03:52 +02002211 CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE
2212 Some GPIO connected LEDs may have inverted polarity in which
2213 case the GPIO high value corresponds to LED off state and
2214 GPIO low value corresponds to LED on state.
2215 In such cases CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE may be defined
2216 with a list of GPIO LEDs that have inverted polarity.
2217
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002218- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
2219
2220 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
2221 on those systems that support this (optional)
2222 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
2223
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002224- I2C Support: CONFIG_SYS_I2C
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002225
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002226 This enable the NEW i2c subsystem, and will allow you to use
2227 i2c commands at the u-boot command line (as long as you set
2228 CONFIG_CMD_I2C in CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c
2229 based realtime clock chips or other i2c devices. See
2230 common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the command line
2231 interface.
2232
2233 ported i2c driver to the new framework:
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002234 - drivers/i2c/soft_i2c.c:
2235 - activate first bus with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT define
2236 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE
2237 for defining speed and slave address
2238 - activate second bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS2 define
2239 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_2 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_2
2240 for defining speed and slave address
2241 - activate third bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS3 define
2242 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_3 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_3
2243 for defining speed and slave address
2244 - activate fourth bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS4 define
2245 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_4 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_4
2246 for defining speed and slave address
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002247
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002248 - drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c:
2249 - activate i2c driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_FSL
2250 define CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_OFFSET for setting the register
2251 offset CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SPEED for the i2c speed and
2252 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SLAVE for the slave addr of the first
2253 bus.
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02002254 - If your board supports a second fsl i2c bus, define
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002255 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_OFFSET for the register offset
2256 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SPEED for the speed and
2257 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SLAVE for the slave address of the
2258 second bus.
2259
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002260 - drivers/i2c/tegra_i2c.c:
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu10cee512013-10-11 16:23:53 +09002261 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_TEGRA
2262 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses with a fix speed from
2263 100000 and the slave addr 0!
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002264
Dirk Eibach880540d2013-04-25 02:40:01 +00002265 - drivers/i2c/ppc4xx_i2c.c
2266 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX
2267 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2268 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2269
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02002270 - drivers/i2c/i2c_mxc.c
2271 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC
2272 - define speed for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SPEED
2273 - define slave for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SLAVE
2274 - define speed for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SPEED
2275 - define slave for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SLAVE
2276 - define speed for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SPEED
2277 - define slave for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SLAVE
2278 If thoses defines are not set, default value is 100000
2279 for speed, and 0 for slave.
2280
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu1086bfa2013-09-27 16:58:30 +09002281 - drivers/i2c/rcar_i2c.c:
2282 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RCAR
2283 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses
2284
2285 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_BASE for setting the register channel 0
2286 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_SPEED for for the speed channel 0
2287 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_BASE for setting the register channel 1
2288 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_SPEED for for the speed channel 1
2289 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_BASE for setting the register channel 2
2290 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_SPEED for for the speed channel 2
2291 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_BASE for setting the register channel 3
2292 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_SPEED for for the speed channel 3
2293 - CONFIF_SYS_RCAR_I2C_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
2294
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu2035d772013-10-29 13:33:51 +09002295 - drivers/i2c/sh_i2c.c:
2296 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH
2297 - This driver adds from 2 to 5 i2c buses
2298
2299 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE0 for setting the register channel 0
2300 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED0 for for the speed channel 0
2301 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE1 for setting the register channel 1
2302 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED1 for for the speed channel 1
2303 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE2 for setting the register channel 2
2304 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED2 for for the speed channel 2
2305 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE3 for setting the register channel 3
2306 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED3 for for the speed channel 3
2307 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE4 for setting the register channel 4
2308 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED4 for for the speed channel 4
2309 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE5 for setting the register channel 5
2310 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED5 for for the speed channel 5
2311 - CONFIF_SYS_I2C_SH_NUM_CONTROLLERS for nummber of i2c buses
2312
Heiko Schocher6789e842013-10-22 11:03:18 +02002313 - drivers/i2c/omap24xx_i2c.c
2314 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_OMAP24XX
2315 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED speed channel 0
2316 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE slave addr channel 0
2317 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED1 speed channel 1
2318 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE1 slave addr channel 1
2319 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED2 speed channel 2
2320 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE2 slave addr channel 2
2321 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED3 speed channel 3
2322 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE3 slave addr channel 3
2323 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED4 speed channel 4
2324 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE4 slave addr channel 4
2325
Heiko Schocher0bdffe72013-11-08 07:30:53 +01002326 - drivers/i2c/zynq_i2c.c
2327 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ
2328 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SPEED for speed setting
2329 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SLAVE for slave addr
2330
Naveen Krishna Che717fc62013-12-06 12:12:38 +05302331 - drivers/i2c/s3c24x0_i2c.c:
2332 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0
2333 - This driver adds i2c buses (11 for Exynos5250, Exynos5420
2334 9 i2c buses for Exynos4 and 1 for S3C24X0 SoCs from Samsung)
2335 with a fix speed from 100000 and the slave addr 0!
2336
Dirk Eibachb46226b2014-07-03 09:28:18 +02002337 - drivers/i2c/ihs_i2c.c
2338 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS
2339 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2340 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0 speed channel 0
2341 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0 slave addr channel 0
2342 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2343 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1 speed channel 1
2344 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1 slave addr channel 1
2345 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH2 activate hardware channel 2
2346 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2 speed channel 2
2347 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2 slave addr channel 2
2348 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH3 activate hardware channel 3
2349 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3 speed channel 3
2350 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3 slave addr channel 3
2351
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002352 additional defines:
2353
2354 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES
2355 Hold the number of i2c busses you want to use. If you
2356 don't use/have i2c muxes on your i2c bus, this
2357 is equal to CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_ADAPTERS, and you can
2358 omit this define.
2359
2360 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS
2361 define this, if you don't use i2c muxes on your hardware.
2362 if CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS is not defined or == 0 you can
2363 omit this define.
2364
2365 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS
2366 define how many muxes are maximal consecutively connected
2367 on one i2c bus. If you not use i2c muxes, omit this
2368 define.
2369
2370 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES
2371 hold a list of busses you want to use, only used if
2372 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS is not defined, for example
2373 a board with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS = 1 and
2374 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES = 9:
2375
2376 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES {{0, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2377 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 1}}}, \
2378 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 2}}}, \
2379 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 3}}}, \
2380 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 4}}}, \
2381 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 5}}}, \
2382 {1, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2383 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 1}}}, \
2384 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 2}}}, \
2385 }
2386
2387 which defines
2388 bus 0 on adapter 0 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002389 bus 1 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 1
2390 bus 2 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 2
2391 bus 3 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 3
2392 bus 4 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 4
2393 bus 5 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 5
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002394 bus 6 on adapter 1 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002395 bus 7 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 1
2396 bus 8 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 2
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002397
2398 If you do not have i2c muxes on your board, omit this define.
2399
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002400- Legacy I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002401
2402 NOTE: It is intended to move drivers to CONFIG_SYS_I2C which
2403 provides the following compelling advantages:
2404
2405 - more than one i2c adapter is usable
2406 - approved multibus support
2407 - better i2c mux support
2408
2409 ** Please consider updating your I2C driver now. **
2410
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002411 These enable legacy I2C serial bus commands. Defining
2412 CONFIG_HARD_I2C will include the appropriate I2C driver
2413 for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002414
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002415 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05002416 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002417 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
2418 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002419 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002420
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002421 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002422
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002423 There are several other quantities that must also be
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002424 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002425
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002426 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002427 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002428 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002429 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002430
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002431 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002432 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002433 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
2434 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
2435 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002436
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05002437 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
2438
2439 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2440 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2441 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
2442 commands until the slave device responds.
2443
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002444 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002445
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002446 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002447 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
2448 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002449
2450 I2C_INIT
2451
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002452 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002453 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002454
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002455 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002456
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002457 I2C_PORT
2458
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002459 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
2460 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
2461 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002462
2463 I2C_ACTIVE
2464
2465 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
2466 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
2467 define can be null.
2468
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002469 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
2470
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002471 I2C_TRISTATE
2472
2473 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
2474 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
2475 define can be null.
2476
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002477 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
2478
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002479 I2C_READ
2480
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002481 Code that returns true if the I2C data line is high,
2482 false if it is low.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002483
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002484 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
2485
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002486 I2C_SDA(bit)
2487
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002488 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C data line high. If it
2489 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002490
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002491 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002492 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002493 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002494
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002495 I2C_SCL(bit)
2496
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002497 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
2498 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002499
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002500 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002501 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002502 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002503
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002504 I2C_DELAY
2505
2506 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
2507 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002508 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002509 like:
2510
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002511 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002512
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04002513 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
2514
2515 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
2516 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
2517 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
2518 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
2519
2520 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
2521 the generic GPIO functions.
2522
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002523 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002524
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002525 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2526 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2527 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
2528 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
2529 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
2530 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
2531 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
2532 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002533
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04002534 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
2535
2536 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
2537 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
2538 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
2539 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
2540 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
2541 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
2542 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
2543 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
2544
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002545 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
2546
2547 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
2548 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
2549 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
2550
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002551 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
2552
2553 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002554 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
2555 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002556 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
2557
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002558 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002559
2560 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002561 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05002562 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
2563 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002564
2565 e.g.
2566 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002567 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002568
2569 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
2570
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002571 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002572 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002573
2574 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
2575
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002576 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002577
2578 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
2579 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
2580
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002581 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002582
2583 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
2584 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
2585
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002586 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002587
2588 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
2589 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
2590
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002591 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07002592
2593 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
2594 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
2595 specified DTT device.
2596
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06002597 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
2598
2599 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2600 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2601 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2602 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2603 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2604 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2605 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002606
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002607- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2608
2609 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2610 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2611 D/As on the SACSng board)
2612
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002613 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2614
2615 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2616 only SH7757 is supported.
2617
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002618 CONFIG_SPI_X
2619
2620 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2621 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2622
2623 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2624
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002625 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2626 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2627 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2628 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2629 defined, the board configuration must define several
2630 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2631 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002632
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002633 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2634
2635 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2636 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2637 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002638 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002639 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2640
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002641 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2642
2643 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002644 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002645
Heiko Schocherf659b572014-07-14 10:22:11 +02002646 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_MXC_WAIT
2647 Timeout for waiting until spi transfer completed.
2648 default: (CONFIG_SYS_HZ/100) /* 10 ms */
2649
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002650- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2651
2652 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2653
2654 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2655
2656 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2657 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2658
2659 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2660
2661 Enables support for FPGA family.
2662 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2663
2664 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002665
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002666 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002667
Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu64e809a2014-03-14 16:35:38 +05302668 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADMK
2669
2670 Enable support for fpga loadmk command
2671
Michal Simek67193862014-05-02 13:43:39 +02002672 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADP
2673
2674 Enable support for fpga loadp command - load partial bitstream
2675
2676 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADBP
2677
2678 Enable support for fpga loadbp command - load partial bitstream
2679 (Xilinx only)
2680
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002681 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002682
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002683 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002684
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002685 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002686
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002687 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2688 status by the configuration function. This option
2689 will require a board or device specific function to
2690 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002691
2692 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2693
2694 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2695 configuration driver.
2696
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002697 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002698 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2699
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002700 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002701
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002702 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2703 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2704 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2705 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002706
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002707 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002708
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002709 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
2710 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
2711 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002712 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002713
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002714 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002715
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002716 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002717 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002718
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002719 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002720
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002721 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002722 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002723
2724- Configuration Management:
2725 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2726
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002727 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2728 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002729
2730- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2731
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002732 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2733 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002734 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002735 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2736 protects these variables from casual modification by
2737 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2738 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002739 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002740
2741 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2742 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002743 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002744 these parameters.
2745
2746 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2747 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002748 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002749 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2750 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2751 read-only.]
2752
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002753 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2754 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2755 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2756 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2757
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002758- Protected RAM:
2759 CONFIG_PRAM
2760
2761 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2762 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2763 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2764 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2765 this default value by defining an environment
2766 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2767 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2768 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2769 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2770 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2771 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2772 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2773
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002774 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002775 saveenv
2776
2777 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2778 either, which results in a memory region that will
2779 not be affected by reboots.
2780
2781 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2782 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2783 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2784 following board configurations are known to be
2785 "pRAM-clean":
2786
Wolfgang Denk1b0757e2012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002787 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2788 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002789 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002790
Gabe Black40fef042012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002791- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2792 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2793 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2794 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2795 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2796 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2797 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2798
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002799- Error Recovery:
2800 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2801
2802 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2803 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2804 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002805 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002806 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2807 useful during development since you can try to debug
2808 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2809
2810 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2811
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002812 This variable defines the number of retries for
2813 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2814 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2815 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002816
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002817 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2818
2819 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2820
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002821 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2822
2823 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2824 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2825 try longer timeout such as
2826 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2827
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002828- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002829 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002830
2831 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2832
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002833 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002834
2835 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2836 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2837 powerful command line syntax like
2838 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2839 constructs ("shell scripts").
2840
2841 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2842 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2843
2844
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002845 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002846
2847 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2848 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2849 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2850
2851 Note:
2852
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002853 In the current implementation, the local variables
2854 space and global environment variables space are
2855 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2856 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2857 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2858 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2859 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002860
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002861 Global environment variables are those you use
2862 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2863 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2864 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002865
2866 To store commands and special characters in a
2867 variable, please use double quotation marks
2868 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2869 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2870 symbols.
2871
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002872- Commandline Editing and History:
2873 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2874
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002875 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkb9365a22006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002876 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002877
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002878- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002879 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2880
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002881 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2882 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002883 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002884
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002885 For example, place something like this in your
2886 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002887
2888 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2889 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2890 "myvar2=value2\0"
2891
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002892 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2893 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2894 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2895 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002896 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002897 You better know what you are doing here.
2898
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002899 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2900 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002901 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002902 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002903
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002904 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2905
2906 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2907 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2908 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2909
2910 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2911
2912 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2913 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2914 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2915 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2916 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2917
Tom Rini7e27f892012-10-24 07:28:16 +00002918 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
2919
2920 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
2921 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
2922 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
2923
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002924 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2925
2926 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
2927 intialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
2928 that so that the environment is not available until
2929 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
2930 this is instead controlled by the value of
2931 /config/load-environment.
2932
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002933- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002934 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2935
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002936 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2937 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2938 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002939
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002940- Serial Flash support
2941 CONFIG_CMD_SF
2942
2943 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
2944 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
2945
2946 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
2947 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2948 commands.
2949
2950 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2951 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2952 flash is present on the system.
2953
2954 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2955 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2956 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2957 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2958
Simon Glass24007272012-10-08 13:16:02 +00002959 CONFIG_CMD_SF_TEST
2960
2961 Define this option to include a destructive SPI flash
2962 test ('sf test').
2963
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki1dcd6d02013-06-19 15:33:58 +05302964 CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_BAR Ban/Extended Addr Reg
2965
2966 Define this option to use the Bank addr/Extended addr
2967 support on SPI flashes which has size > 16Mbytes.
2968
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Tekib902e072014-01-11 15:25:04 +05302969 CONFIG_SF_DUAL_FLASH Dual flash memories
2970
2971 Define this option to use dual flash support where two flash
2972 memories can be connected with a given cs line.
2973 currently Xilinx Zynq qspi support these type of connections.
2974
Heiko Schocher562f8df2014-07-18 06:07:21 +02002975 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_ST_ENABLE_WP_PIN
2976 enable the W#/Vpp signal to disable writing to the status
2977 register on ST MICRON flashes like the N25Q128.
2978 The status register write enable/disable bit, combined with
2979 the W#/VPP signal provides hardware data protection for the
2980 device as follows: When the enable/disable bit is set to 1,
2981 and the W#/VPP signal is driven LOW, the status register
2982 nonvolatile bits become read-only and the WRITE STATUS REGISTER
2983 operation will not execute. The only way to exit this
2984 hardware-protected mode is to drive W#/VPP HIGH.
2985
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002986- SystemACE Support:
2987 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2988
2989 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2990 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002991 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002992 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002993
2994 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002995 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002996
2997 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2998 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2999
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003000- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
3001 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
3002
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003003 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003004 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003005 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003006 number generator is used.
3007
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003008 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
3009 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
3010 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
3011
3012 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003013 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
3014 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
3015 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
3016 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
3017 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
3018 but sometimes that is not allowed.
3019
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00003020- Hashing support:
3021 CONFIG_CMD_HASH
3022
3023 This enables a generic 'hash' command which can produce
3024 hashes / digests from a few algorithms (e.g. SHA1, SHA256).
3025
3026 CONFIG_HASH_VERIFY
3027
3028 Enable the hash verify command (hash -v). This adds to code
3029 size a little.
3030
3031 CONFIG_SHA1 - support SHA1 hashing
3032 CONFIG_SHA256 - support SHA256 hashing
3033
3034 Note: There is also a sha1sum command, which should perhaps
3035 be deprecated in favour of 'hash sha1'.
3036
Robert Winklera11f1872013-07-24 17:57:06 -07003037- Freescale i.MX specific commands:
3038 CONFIG_CMD_HDMIDETECT
3039 This enables 'hdmidet' command which returns true if an
3040 HDMI monitor is detected. This command is i.MX 6 specific.
3041
3042 CONFIG_CMD_BMODE
3043 This enables the 'bmode' (bootmode) command for forcing
3044 a boot from specific media.
3045
3046 This is useful for forcing the ROM's usb downloader to
3047 activate upon a watchdog reset which is nice when iterating
3048 on U-Boot. Using the reset button or running bmode normal
3049 will set it back to normal. This command currently
3050 supports i.MX53 and i.MX6.
3051
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003052- Signing support:
3053 CONFIG_RSA
3054
3055 This enables the RSA algorithm used for FIT image verification
Detlev Zundel8bf2aad2014-01-20 16:21:46 +01003056 in U-Boot. See doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more information.
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003057
3058 The signing part is build into mkimage regardless of this
3059 option.
3060
Heiko Schocher9e50c402014-01-25 07:27:13 +01003061- bootcount support:
3062 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
3063
3064 This enables the bootcounter support, see:
3065 http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
3066
3067 CONFIG_AT91SAM9XE
3068 enable special bootcounter support on at91sam9xe based boards.
3069 CONFIG_BLACKFIN
3070 enable special bootcounter support on blackfin based boards.
3071 CONFIG_SOC_DA8XX
3072 enable special bootcounter support on da850 based boards.
3073 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_RAM
3074 enable support for the bootcounter in RAM
3075 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_I2C
3076 enable support for the bootcounter on an i2c (like RTC) device.
3077 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RTC_ADDR = i2c chip address
3078 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_ADDR = i2c addr which is used for
3079 the bootcounter.
3080 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ALEN = address len
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003081
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003082- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003083 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
3084
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003085 Defining this option allows to add some board-
3086 specific code (calling a user-provided function
3087 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
3088 the system's boot progress on some display (for
3089 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
3090 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003091
Simon Glass3a608ca2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00003092- Detailed boot stage timing
3093 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
3094 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
3095 of the boot process.
3096
3097 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
3098 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
3099 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
3100 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
3101 the limit, recording will stop.
3102
3103 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
3104 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
3105
3106 Timer summary in microseconds:
3107 Mark Elapsed Stage
3108 0 0 reset
3109 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
3110 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
3111 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
3112 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
3113 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
3114 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
3115 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
3116
Simon Glass2eba38c2012-09-28 08:56:39 +00003117 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTSTAGE
3118 Add a 'bootstage' command which supports printing a report
3119 and un/stashing of bootstage data.
3120
Simon Glass94fd1312012-09-28 08:56:37 +00003121 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_FDT
3122 Stash the bootstage information in the FDT. A root 'bootstage'
3123 node is created with each bootstage id as a child. Each child
3124 has a 'name' property and either 'mark' containing the
3125 mark time in microsecond, or 'accum' containing the
3126 accumulated time for that bootstage id in microseconds.
3127 For example:
3128
3129 bootstage {
3130 154 {
3131 name = "board_init_f";
3132 mark = <3575678>;
3133 };
3134 170 {
3135 name = "lcd";
3136 accum = <33482>;
3137 };
3138 };
3139
3140 Code in the Linux kernel can find this in /proc/devicetree.
3141
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003142Legacy uImage format:
3143
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003144 Arg Where When
3145 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003146 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003147 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003148 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003149 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003150 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003151 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
3152 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
3153 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003154 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003155 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
3156 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
3157 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
3158 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003159 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003160 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003161
3162 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3163 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
3164 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
3165 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
3166 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
3167 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
3168 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003169 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003170 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
3171 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
3172
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003173 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003174
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003175 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd542004-02-27 00:07:27 +00003176 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
3177 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00003178
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003179 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
3180 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
3181 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
3182 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
3183 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
3184 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
3185 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
3186 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
3187 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
3188 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
3189 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
3190 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
3191 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
3192 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
3193 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
3194 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
3195 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
3196 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
3197 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
3198 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
3199 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
3200 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
3201 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
3202 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
3203 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
3204 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
3205 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
3206 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
3207 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
3208 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
3209 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
3210 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
3211 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
3212 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
3213 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
3214 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
3215 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
3216 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
3217 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
3218 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
3219 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
3220 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
3221 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
3222 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
3223 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
3224 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
3225 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003226
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003227 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003228
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003229 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003230 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
3231 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00003232
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003233 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
3234 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003235 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003236 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
3237 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
3238 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02003239 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
3240 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003241 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003242
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003243FIT uImage format:
3244
3245 Arg Where When
3246 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
3247 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
3248 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
3249 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
3250 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
3251 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01003252 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003253 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
3254 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
3255 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
3256 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
3257 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003258 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
3259 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003260 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
3261 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
3262 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
3263 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
3264 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
3265 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
3266 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
3267 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
3268
3269 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3270 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
3271 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003272 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003273 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
3274 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
3275 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
3276 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
3277 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
3278 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
3279 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
3280 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
3281 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
3282 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
3283 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
3284 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
3285
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003286 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003287 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
3288
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003289 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003290 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
3291
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003292 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003293 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
3294
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02003295- legacy image format:
3296 CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
3297 enables the legacy image format support in U-Boot.
3298
3299 Default:
3300 enabled if CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE is not defined.
3301
3302 CONFIG_DISABLE_IMAGE_LEGACY
3303 disable the legacy image format
3304
3305 This define is introduced, as the legacy image format is
3306 enabled per default for backward compatibility.
3307
Gabe Blackd95f6ec2012-10-25 16:31:10 +00003308- FIT image support:
3309 CONFIG_FIT
3310 Enable support for the FIT uImage format.
3311
3312 CONFIG_FIT_BEST_MATCH
3313 When no configuration is explicitly selected, default to the
3314 one whose fdt's compatibility field best matches that of
3315 U-Boot itself. A match is considered "best" if it matches the
3316 most specific compatibility entry of U-Boot's fdt's root node.
3317 The order of entries in the configuration's fdt is ignored.
3318
Simon Glass3e569a62013-06-13 15:10:00 -07003319 CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE
3320 This option enables signature verification of FIT uImages,
3321 using a hash signed and verified using RSA. See
3322 doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more details.
3323
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02003324 WARNING: When relying on signed FIT images with required
3325 signature check the legacy image format is default
3326 disabled. If a board need legacy image format support
3327 enable this through CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
3328
Dirk Eibach9a4f4792014-07-03 09:28:26 +02003329 CONFIG_FIT_DISABLE_SHA256
3330 Supporting SHA256 hashes has quite an impact on binary size.
3331 For constrained systems sha256 hash support can be disabled
3332 with this option.
3333
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003334- Standalone program support:
3335 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
3336
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02003337 This option defines a board specific value for the
3338 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
3339 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003340 settings.
3341
3342- Frame Buffer Address:
3343 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
3344
3345 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denk44a53b52013-01-03 00:43:59 +00003346 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
3347 when using a graphics controller has separate video
3348 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
3349 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
3350 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
3351 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
3352 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003353
3354 Please see board_init_f function.
3355
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01003356- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
3357 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
3358 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
3359 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
3360
3361 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
3362 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
3363
3364- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
3365 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
3366
3367 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
3368 Needed for mtdparts command support.
3369
3370 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
3371
3372 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
3373 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
3374
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02003375 CONFIG_MTD_NAND_VERIFY_WRITE
3376 verify if the written data is correct reread.
3377
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003378- UBI support
3379 CONFIG_CMD_UBI
3380
3381 Adds commands for interacting with MTD partitions formatted
3382 with the UBI flash translation layer
3383
3384 Requires also defining CONFIG_RBTREE
3385
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003386 CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
3387
3388 Make the verbose messages from UBI stop printing. This leaves
3389 warnings and errors enabled.
3390
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02003391
3392 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_WL_THRESHOLD
3393 This parameter defines the maximum difference between the highest
3394 erase counter value and the lowest erase counter value of eraseblocks
3395 of UBI devices. When this threshold is exceeded, UBI starts performing
3396 wear leveling by means of moving data from eraseblock with low erase
3397 counter to eraseblocks with high erase counter.
3398
3399 The default value should be OK for SLC NAND flashes, NOR flashes and
3400 other flashes which have eraseblock life-cycle 100000 or more.
3401 However, in case of MLC NAND flashes which typically have eraseblock
3402 life-cycle less than 10000, the threshold should be lessened (e.g.,
3403 to 128 or 256, although it does not have to be power of 2).
3404
3405 default: 4096
3406
3407 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_BEB_LIMIT
3408 This option specifies the maximum bad physical eraseblocks UBI
3409 expects on the MTD device (per 1024 eraseblocks). If the
3410 underlying flash does not admit of bad eraseblocks (e.g. NOR
3411 flash), this value is ignored.
3412
3413 NAND datasheets often specify the minimum and maximum NVM
3414 (Number of Valid Blocks) for the flashes' endurance lifetime.
3415 The maximum expected bad eraseblocks per 1024 eraseblocks
3416 then can be calculated as "1024 * (1 - MinNVB / MaxNVB)",
3417 which gives 20 for most NANDs (MaxNVB is basically the total
3418 count of eraseblocks on the chip).
3419
3420 To put it differently, if this value is 20, UBI will try to
3421 reserve about 1.9% of physical eraseblocks for bad blocks
3422 handling. And that will be 1.9% of eraseblocks on the entire
3423 NAND chip, not just the MTD partition UBI attaches. This means
3424 that if you have, say, a NAND flash chip admits maximum 40 bad
3425 eraseblocks, and it is split on two MTD partitions of the same
3426 size, UBI will reserve 40 eraseblocks when attaching a
3427 partition.
3428
3429 default: 20
3430
3431 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP
3432 Fastmap is a mechanism which allows attaching an UBI device
3433 in nearly constant time. Instead of scanning the whole MTD device it
3434 only has to locate a checkpoint (called fastmap) on the device.
3435 The on-flash fastmap contains all information needed to attach
3436 the device. Using fastmap makes only sense on large devices where
3437 attaching by scanning takes long. UBI will not automatically install
3438 a fastmap on old images, but you can set the UBI parameter
3439 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT to 1 if you want so. Please note
3440 that fastmap-enabled images are still usable with UBI implementations
3441 without fastmap support. On typical flash devices the whole fastmap
3442 fits into one PEB. UBI will reserve PEBs to hold two fastmaps.
3443
3444 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT
3445 Set this parameter to enable fastmap automatically on images
3446 without a fastmap.
3447 default: 0
3448
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003449- UBIFS support
3450 CONFIG_CMD_UBIFS
3451
3452 Adds commands for interacting with UBI volumes formatted as
3453 UBIFS. UBIFS is read-only in u-boot.
3454
3455 Requires UBI support as well as CONFIG_LZO
3456
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003457 CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
3458
3459 Make the verbose messages from UBIFS stop printing. This leaves
3460 warnings and errors enabled.
3461
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003462- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003463 CONFIG_SPL
3464 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003465
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003466 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
3467 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
3468
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003469 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT
3470 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL, BSS included.
3471 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory
3472 used by SPL from _start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003473 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003474 must not be both defined at the same time.
3475
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003476 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003477 Maximum size of the SPL image (text, data, rodata, and
3478 linker lists sections), BSS excluded.
3479 When defined, the linker checks that the actual size does
3480 not exceed it.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003481
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003482 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
3483 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003484
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003485 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
3486 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
3487 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
3488
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003489 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
3490 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
3491
3492 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003493 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL BSS.
3494 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory used
3495 by SPL from __bss_start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003496 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003497 must not be both defined at the same time.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003498
3499 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
3500 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
3501
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003502 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
3503 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
3504 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
3505 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
3506
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003507 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
3508 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
3509
3510 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
3511 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003512
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07003513 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
3514 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
3515 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
3516 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
3517
Tom Rini9607faf2014-03-28 12:03:39 -04003518 CONFIG_SPL_OS_BOOT
3519 Enable booting directly to an OS from SPL.
3520 See also: doc/README.falcon
3521
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07003522 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
3523 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
3524 about the running system.
3525
Scott Wood4b919722012-09-20 16:35:21 -05003526 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
3527 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
3528
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003529 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
3530 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003531
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003532 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
3533 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003534
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003535 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
3536 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003537
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003538 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
3539 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003540
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003541 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
3542 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003543
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003544 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
3545 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
3546 CONFIG_SYS_MMC_SD_FAT_BOOT_PARTITION
3547 Address, size and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
3548 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
3549
Peter Korsgaard2b75b0a2013-05-13 08:36:29 +00003550 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_KERNEL_SECTOR
3551 Sector to load kernel uImage from when MMC is being
3552 used in raw mode (for Falcon mode)
3553
3554 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTOR,
3555 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTORS
3556 Sector and number of sectors to load kernel argument
3557 parameters from when MMC is being used in raw mode
3558 (for falcon mode)
3559
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003560 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
3561 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
3562
3563 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
3564 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from FAT
3565
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003566 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_KERNEL_NAME
3567 Filename to read to load kernel uImage when reading
3568 from FAT (for Falcon mode)
3569
3570 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_ARGS_NAME
3571 Filename to read to load kernel argument parameters
3572 when reading from FAT (for Falcon mode)
3573
Scott Wood06f60ae2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00003574 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
3575 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
3576 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
3577 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
3578 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
3579
Prabhakar Kushwaha651fcf62014-04-08 19:12:31 +05303580 CONFIG_SPL_SKIP_RELOCATE
3581 Avoid SPL relocation
3582
Scott Wood6f2f01b2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05003583 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
3584 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
3585 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
3586
3587 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
3588 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
3589
3590 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
3591 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
3592
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003593 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003594 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
3595 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003596
Tom Rini6dd3b562014-03-28 12:03:36 -04003597 CONFIG_SPL_MTD_SUPPORT
3598 Support for the MTD subsystem within SPL. Useful for
3599 environment on NAND support within SPL.
3600
Ying Zhangbb0dc102013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003601 CONFIG_SPL_MPC8XXX_INIT_DDR_SUPPORT
3602 Set for the SPL on PPC mpc8xxx targets, support for
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -07003603 drivers/ddr/fsl/libddr.o in SPL binary.
Ying Zhangbb0dc102013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003604
Ying Zhang7c8eea52013-08-16 15:16:12 +08003605 CONFIG_SPL_COMMON_INIT_DDR
3606 Set for common ddr init with serial presence detect in
3607 SPL binary.
3608
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003609 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
3610 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
3611 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
3612 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
3613 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
3614 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003615 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003616
Prabhakar Kushwahafbe76ae2013-12-11 12:42:11 +05303617 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BOOT
3618 Add support NAND boot
3619
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003620 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003621 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
3622
3623 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
3624 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
3625
3626 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
3627 Size of image to load
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003628
3629 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003630 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003631
3632 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
3633 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
3634 data. This is used for example on davinci plattforms.
3635
3636 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
3637 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
3638 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
3639
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003640 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
3641 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003642
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003643 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
3644 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003645
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003646 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
3647 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003648
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02003649 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
3650 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
3651
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003652 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
3653 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003654
Ying Zhangba1bee42013-05-20 14:07:25 +08003655 CONFIG_SPL_ENV_SUPPORT
3656 Support for the environment operating in SPL binary
3657
3658 CONFIG_SPL_NET_SUPPORT
3659 Support for the net/libnet.o in SPL binary.
3660 It conflicts with SPL env from storage medium specified by
3661 CONFIG_ENV_IS_xxx but CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE
3662
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003663 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
Benoît Thébaudeau6113d3f2013-04-11 09:35:49 +00003664 Image offset to which the SPL should be padded before appending
3665 the SPL payload. By default, this is defined as
3666 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3667 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3668 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003669
Scott Woodca2fca22012-09-21 16:27:32 -05003670 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
3671 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
3672 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
3673 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
3674
Simon Glass87ebee32013-05-08 08:05:59 +00003675 CONFIG_FIT_SPL_PRINT
3676 Printing information about a FIT image adds quite a bit of
3677 code to SPL. So this is normally disabled in SPL. Use this
3678 option to re-enable it. This will affect the output of the
3679 bootm command when booting a FIT image.
3680
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003681- TPL framework
3682 CONFIG_TPL
3683 Enable building of TPL globally.
3684
3685 CONFIG_TPL_PAD_TO
3686 Image offset to which the TPL should be padded before appending
3687 the TPL payload. By default, this is defined as
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02003688 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3689 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3690 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003691
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003692Modem Support:
3693--------------
3694
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02003695[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003696
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003697- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003698 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
3699
3700- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
3701 CONFIG_HWFLOW
3702
3703- Modem debug support:
3704 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
3705
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003706 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
3707 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003708
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003709- Interrupt support (PPC):
3710
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003711 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
3712 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003713 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003714 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003715 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003716 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003717 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003718 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
3719 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
3720 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003721
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003722- General:
3723
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003724 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
3725 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
3726 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003727 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003728 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
3729 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
3730 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003731
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003732 If there are no modem init strings in the
3733 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
3734 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003735 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003736
3737 See also: doc/README.Modem
3738
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00003739Board initialization settings:
3740------------------------------
3741
3742During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
3743to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
3744before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
3745following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
3746architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
3747typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
3748
3749- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
3750- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
3751- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
3752- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003753
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003754Configuration Settings:
3755-----------------------
3756
York Sun4d1fd7f2014-02-26 17:03:19 -08003757- CONFIG_SYS_SUPPORT_64BIT_DATA: Defined automatically if compiled as 64-bit.
3758 Optionally it can be defined to support 64-bit memory commands.
3759
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003760- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003761 undefine this when you're short of memory.
3762
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06003763- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
3764 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
3765
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003766- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003767 prompt for user input.
3768
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003769- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003770
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003771- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003772
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003773- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003774
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003775- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003776 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
3777 booted
3778
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003779- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003780 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
3781
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003782- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003783 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003784
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003785- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003786 If the board specific function
3787 extern int overwrite_console (void);
3788 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003789 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
3790
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003791- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003792 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003793
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003794- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003795 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
3796
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003797- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003798 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
3799 simple memory test.
3800
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003801- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003802 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003803
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003804- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00003805 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
3806 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
3807
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003808- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
3809 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003810 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003811 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003812 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
3813 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
3814 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003815 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003816 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003817 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003818
3819 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
3820 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
3821 be touched.
3822
3823 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
3824 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
3825 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
3826 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
3827 problems.
3828
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003829- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003830 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
3831
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003832- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003833 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
3834
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003835- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003836 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
3837 Cogent motherboard)
3838
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003839- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003840 Physical start address of Flash memory.
3841
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003842- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003843 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
3844 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02003845 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003846 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003847
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003848- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003849 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
3850 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
3851 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
3852 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003853
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003854- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003855 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
3856
Simon Glassd59476b2014-07-10 22:23:28 -06003857- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN
3858 Size of the malloc() pool for use before relocation. If
3859 this is defined, then a very simple malloc() implementation
3860 will become available before relocation. The address is just
3861 below the global data, and the stack is moved down to make
3862 space.
3863
3864 This feature allocates regions with increasing addresses
3865 within the region. calloc() is supported, but realloc()
3866 is not available. free() is supported but does nothing.
3867 The memory will be freed (or in fact just forgotton) when
3868 U-Boot relocates itself.
3869
Simon Glasse7b14e92014-09-15 06:33:18 -06003870 Pre-relocation malloc() is only supported on ARM and sandbox
Simon Glass29afe9e2014-07-10 22:23:31 -06003871 at present but is fairly easy to enable for other archs.
3872
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003873- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003874 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
3875 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003876 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003877 to adjust this setting to your needs.
3878
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003879- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003880 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
3881 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003882 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
3883 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04003884 environment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003885 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003886 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003887 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
3888 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
3889 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003890
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06003891- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
3892 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
3893 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
3894 is enabled.
3895
3896- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
3897 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
3898 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3899
3900- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
3901 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
3902 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3903
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003904- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003905 Max number of Flash memory banks
3906
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003907- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003908 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
3909
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003910- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003911 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
3912
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003913- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003914 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
3915
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003916- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003917 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
3918
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003919- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003920 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
3921
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003922- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003923 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
3924 instead of U-Boot software protection.
3925
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003926- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003927
3928 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
3929 without this option such a download has to be
3930 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
3931 copy from RAM to flash.
3932
3933 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
3934 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003935 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
3936 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003937 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
3938
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003939- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003940 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003941 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
3942
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02003943- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003944 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
3945 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003946
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01003947- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
3948 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
3949 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
3950 to the MTD layer.
3951
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003952- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02003953 Use buffered writes to flash.
3954
3955- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
3956 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
3957 write commands.
3958
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003959- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01003960 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
3961 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
3962 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
3963 optionally available.
3964
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05003965- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
3966 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
3967 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
3968 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
3969
Stefan Roese352ef3f2013-04-04 15:53:14 +02003970- CONFIG_FLASH_VERIFY
3971 If defined, the content of the flash (destination) is compared
3972 against the source after the write operation. An error message
3973 will be printed when the contents are not identical.
3974 Please note that this option is useless in nearly all cases,
3975 since such flash programming errors usually are detected earlier
3976 while unprotecting/erasing/programming. Please only enable
3977 this option if you really know what you are doing.
3978
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003979- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003980 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
3981 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003982 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
3983 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003984 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003985 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
3986
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003987- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
3988
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02003989 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
3990 internally to store the environment settings. The default
3991 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
3992 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
3993 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003994
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003995- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3996- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04003997 Enable validation of the values given to environment variables when
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003998 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
3999 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
4000 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
4001
4002 The format of the list is:
4003 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004004 access_atribute = [a|r|o|c]
4005 attributes = type_attribute[access_atribute]
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004006 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
4007 list = entry[,list]
4008
4009 The type attributes are:
4010 s - String (default)
4011 d - Decimal
4012 x - Hexadecimal
4013 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
4014 i - IP address
4015 m - MAC address
4016
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004017 The access attributes are:
4018 a - Any (default)
4019 r - Read-only
4020 o - Write-once
4021 c - Change-default
4022
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004023 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
4024 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
4025 envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
4026
4027 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
4028 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
4029 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
4030 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
4031 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
4032 ".flags" variable.
4033
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004034- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
4035 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
4036 access flags.
4037
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00004038- CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_BOARD
4039 This selects the architecture-generic board system instead of the
4040 architecture-specific board files. It is intended to move boards
4041 to this new framework over time. Defining this will disable the
4042 arch/foo/lib/board.c file and use common/board_f.c and
4043 common/board_r.c instead. To use this option your architecture
4044 must support it (i.e. must define __HAVE_ARCH_GENERIC_BOARD in
4045 its config.mk file). If you find problems enabling this option on
4046 your board please report the problem and send patches!
4047
Lokesh Vutla0b1b60c2013-04-17 20:49:40 +00004048- CONFIG_OMAP_PLATFORM_RESET_TIME_MAX_USEC (OMAP only)
4049 This is set by OMAP boards for the max time that reset should
4050 be asserted. See doc/README.omap-reset-time for details on how
4051 the value can be calulated on a given board.
Simon Glass632efa72013-03-11 07:06:48 +00004052
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004053The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
4054of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
4055following configurations:
4056
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00004057- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
4058
4059 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
4060 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
4061
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02004062- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004063
4064 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
4065
4066 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
4067 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
4068 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
4069 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
4070 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
4071 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
4072 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
4073 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
4074 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
4075 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
4076 between U-Boot and the environment.
4077
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004078 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004079
4080 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
4081 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
4082 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
4083 for this sector is given here.
4084
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004085 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004086
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004087 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004088
4089 This is just another way to specify the start address of
4090 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004091 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004092
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004093 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004094
4095 Size of the sector containing the environment.
4096
4097
4098 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
4099 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
4100 the environment.
4101
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004102 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004103
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02004104 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004105 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004106 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
4107 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
4108
4109 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
4110 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
4111 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
4112 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
4113 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
4114 updating the environment in flash makes it always
4115 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
4116 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
4117 RAM, your target system will be dead.
4118
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004119 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
4120 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004121
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004122 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004123 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00004124 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004125 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004126
4127BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
4128source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
4129accordingly!
4130
4131
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02004132- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004133
4134 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
4135 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
4136 environment.
4137
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004138 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4139 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004140
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004141 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004142 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
4143 can just be read and written to, without any special
4144 provision.
4145
4146BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
4147in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004148console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004149U-Boot will hang.
4150
4151Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
4152environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
4153keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
4154to save the current settings.
4155
4156
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02004157- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004158
4159 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
4160 device and a driver for it.
4161
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004162 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4163 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004164
4165 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
4166 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
4167
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004168 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004169 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
4170 The default address is zero.
4171
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004172 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004173 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
4174 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
4175 would require six bits.
4176
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004177 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004178 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00004179 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004180
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004181 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004182 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
4183 that this is NOT the chip address length!
4184
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004185 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004186 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
4187 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
4188 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
4189 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
4190 byte chips.
4191
4192 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
4193 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
4194 in the chip address.
4195
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004196 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004197 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
4198
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01004199 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
4200 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
4201 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
4202
4203 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
4204 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
4205 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
4206 EEPROM. For example:
4207
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01004208 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS 1
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01004209
4210 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
4211 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004212
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02004213- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004214
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00004215 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004216 want to use for the environment.
4217
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004218 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4219 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4220 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004221
4222 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
4223 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
4224 at the specified address.
4225
Wu, Joshbd83b592014-07-01 19:30:13 +08004226- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_SPI_FLASH:
4227
4228 Define this if you have a SPI Flash memory device which you
4229 want to use for the environment.
4230
4231 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4232 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4233
4234 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
4235 environment area within the SPI Flash. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
4236 aligned to an erase sector boundary.
4237
4238 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
4239
4240 Define the SPI flash's sector size.
4241
4242 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4243
4244 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
4245 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
4246 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
4247 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
4248 aligned to an erase sector boundary.
4249
4250 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_BUS (optional):
4251 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_CS (optional):
4252
4253 Define the SPI bus and chip select. If not defined they will be 0.
4254
4255 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MAX_HZ (optional):
4256
4257 Define the SPI max work clock. If not defined then use 1MHz.
4258
4259 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MODE (optional):
4260
4261 Define the SPI work mode. If not defined then use SPI_MODE_3.
4262
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004263- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
4264
4265 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
4266 want to use for the local device's environment.
4267
4268 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4269 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4270
4271 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
4272 environment area within the remote memory space. The
4273 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004274 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004275
4276BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
4277"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004278environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
4279but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004280
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02004281- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00004282
4283 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
4284 for the environment.
4285
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004286 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4287 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00004288
4289 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004290 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
4291 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004292
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004293 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004294
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004295 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004296 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
4297 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004298 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004299 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004300
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004301 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
4302
4303 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
4304 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
4305 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
4306 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
4307 the range to be avoided.
4308
4309 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
4310
4311 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
4312 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
4313 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
4314 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
4315 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004316
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02004317- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
4318
4319 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
4320 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
4321 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4322
Joe Hershberger2b744332013-04-08 10:32:51 +00004323- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_UBI:
4324
4325 Define this if you have an UBI volume that you want to use for the
4326 environment. This has the benefit of wear-leveling the environment
4327 accesses, which is important on NAND.
4328
4329 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_PART:
4330
4331 Define this to a string that is the mtd partition containing the UBI.
4332
4333 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME:
4334
4335 Define this to the name of the volume that you want to store the
4336 environment in.
4337
Joe Hershberger785881f2013-04-08 10:32:52 +00004338 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME_REDUND:
4339
4340 Define this to the name of another volume to store a second copy of
4341 the environment in. This will enable redundant environments in UBI.
4342 It is assumed that both volumes are in the same MTD partition.
4343
Joe Hershberger2b744332013-04-08 10:32:51 +00004344 - CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
4345 - CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
4346
4347 You will probably want to define these to avoid a really noisy system
4348 when storing the env in UBI.
4349
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004350- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FAT:
4351 Define this if you want to use the FAT file system for the environment.
4352
4353 - FAT_ENV_INTERFACE:
4354
4355 Define this to a string that is the name of the block device.
4356
4357 - FAT_ENV_DEV_AND_PART:
4358
4359 Define this to a string to specify the partition of the device. It can
4360 be as following:
4361
4362 "D:P", "D:0", "D", "D:" or "D:auto" (D, P are integers. And P >= 1)
4363 - "D:P": device D partition P. Error occurs if device D has no
4364 partition table.
4365 - "D:0": device D.
4366 - "D" or "D:": device D partition 1 if device D has partition
4367 table, or the whole device D if has no partition
4368 table.
4369 - "D:auto": first partition in device D with bootable flag set.
4370 If none, first valid paratition in device D. If no
4371 partition table then means device D.
4372
4373 - FAT_ENV_FILE:
4374
4375 It's a string of the FAT file name. This file use to store the
4376 envrionment.
4377
4378 - CONFIG_FAT_WRITE:
4379 This should be defined. Otherwise it cannot save the envrionment file.
4380
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004381- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_MMC:
4382
4383 Define this if you have an MMC device which you want to use for the
4384 environment.
4385
4386 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV:
4387
4388 Specifies which MMC device the environment is stored in.
4389
4390 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_PART (optional):
4391
4392 Specifies which MMC partition the environment is stored in. If not
4393 set, defaults to partition 0, the user area. Common values might be
4394 1 (first MMC boot partition), 2 (second MMC boot partition).
4395
4396 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4397 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4398
4399 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
4400 area within the specified MMC device.
4401
Stephen Warren5c088ee2013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004402 If offset is positive (the usual case), it is treated as relative to
4403 the start of the MMC partition. If offset is negative, it is treated
4404 as relative to the end of the MMC partition. This can be useful if
4405 your board may be fitted with different MMC devices, which have
4406 different sizes for the MMC partitions, and you always want the
4407 environment placed at the very end of the partition, to leave the
4408 maximum possible space before it, to store other data.
4409
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004410 These two values are in units of bytes, but must be aligned to an
4411 MMC sector boundary.
4412
4413 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4414
4415 Specifies a second storage area, of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE size, used to
4416 hold a redundant copy of the environment data. This provides a
4417 valid backup copy in case the other copy is corrupted, e.g. due
4418 to a power failure during a "saveenv" operation.
4419
Stephen Warren5c088ee2013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004420 This value may also be positive or negative; this is handled in the
4421 same way as CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET.
4422
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004423 This value is also in units of bytes, but must also be aligned to
4424 an MMC sector boundary.
4425
4426 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND (optional):
4427
4428 This value need not be set, even when CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is
4429 set. If this value is set, it must be set to the same value as
4430 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4431
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004432- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004433
4434 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
4435 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
4436 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
4437 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
4438 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
4439 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
4440 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
4441
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07004442Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004443has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02004444created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004445until then to read environment variables.
4446
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004447The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
4448is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
4449with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
4450necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
4451"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
4452have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004453
4454Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
4455the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004456use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004457
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004458- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004459 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004460
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004461 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004462 also needs to be defined.
4463
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004464- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004465 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004466
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08004467- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
4468 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
4469 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
4470 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
4471 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
4472 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
4473
Simon Glassb2b92f52012-11-30 13:01:18 +00004474- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
4475 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
4476 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
4477 to do this.
4478
Simon Glasse2e3e2b2012-11-30 13:01:19 +00004479- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
4480 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
4481 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
4482 present.
4483
Sascha Silbefeb85802013-08-11 16:40:43 +02004484- CONFIG_BOARD_SIZE_LIMIT:
4485 Maximum size of the U-Boot image. When defined, the
4486 build system checks that the actual size does not
4487 exceed it.
4488
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004489Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00004490---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004491
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004492- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004493 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
4494
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004495- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004496 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00004497
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004498 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
4499 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
4500 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004501
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004502- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
4503 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
4504 PowerPC SOCs.
4505
4506- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
4507 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
4508 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
4509
4510 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
4511 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
4512
4513- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
4514 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
4515 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004516 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004517 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
4518 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
4519 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
4520
4521 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
4522 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
4523
4524- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02004525 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
4526 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004527 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4528 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4529
4530- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
4531 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
4532 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4533 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4534
4535- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
4536 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
4537 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
4538
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004539- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004540 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004541
4542 the default drive number (default value 0)
4543
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004544 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004545
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004546 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004547 (default value 1)
4548
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004549 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004550
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004551 defines the offset of register from address. It
4552 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004553 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004554
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004555 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
4556 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004557 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004558
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004559 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004560 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
4561 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
4562 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
4563 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004564
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00004565- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
4566 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
4567 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
4568 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
4569 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
4570 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
4571 is requierd.
4572
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004573- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004574 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00004575 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004576
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004577- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004578
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00004579 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004580 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
4581 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
4582 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
4583 will become available only after programming the
4584 memory controller and running certain initialization
4585 sequences.
4586
4587 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
4588 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
4589 - MPC824X: data cache
4590 - PPC4xx: data cache
4591
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004592- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004593
4594 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004595 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
4596 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004597 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02004598 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004599 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
4600 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
4601 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004602
4603 Note:
4604 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
4605 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004606 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004607 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
4608 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
4609
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004610- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004611
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004612- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004613
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004614- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004615
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004616- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004617
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004618- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004619
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004620- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004621
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004622- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004623 SDRAM timing
4624
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004625- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004626 periodic timer for refresh
4627
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004628- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004629
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004630- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
4631 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
4632 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
4633 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004634 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
4635
4636- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004637 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
4638 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004639 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
4640
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004641- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
4642 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004643 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
4644 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
4645
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004646- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004647 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4648 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
4649
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004650- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01004651 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4652 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
4653
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004654- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004655 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4656 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
4657
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004658- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004659 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
4660 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
4661 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
4662
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004663- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004664 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
4665 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
4666 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
4667 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00004668
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004669- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4670 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
4671 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
4672 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4673 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
4674 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
4675 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
4676 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004677 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00004678
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01004679- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
4680 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
4681 required.
4682
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00004683- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
4684 Only scan through and get the devices on the busses.
4685 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
4686 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
4687 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
4688 by coreboot or similar.
4689
Gabor Juhos842033e2013-05-30 07:06:12 +00004690- CONFIG_PCI_INDIRECT_BRIDGE:
4691 Enable support for indirect PCI bridges.
4692
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004693- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
4694 Chip has SRIO or not
4695
4696- CONFIG_SRIO1:
4697 Board has SRIO 1 port available
4698
4699- CONFIG_SRIO2:
4700 Board has SRIO 2 port available
4701
Liu Gangc8b28152013-05-07 16:30:46 +08004702- CONFIG_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT_MASTER
4703 Board can support master function for Boot from SRIO and PCIE
4704
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004705- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
4706 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4707
4708- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
4709 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4710
4711- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
4712 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4713
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004714- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BUSWIDTH_16BIT
4715 Defined to tell the NAND controller that the NAND chip is using
4716 a 16 bit bus.
4717 Not all NAND drivers use this symbol.
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004718 Example of drivers that use it:
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004719 - drivers/mtd/nand/ndfc.c
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004720 - drivers/mtd/nand/mxc_nand.c
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04004721
4722- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
4723 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
4724 a default value will be used.
4725
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004726- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004727 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
4728 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
4729
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004730 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
4731 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
4732
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004733- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004734 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
4735 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
4736 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004737
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08004738- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
4739 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
4740 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
4741 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
4742 header files or board specific files.
4743
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07004744- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
4745 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
4746
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004747- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004748 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
4749 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06004750
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004751- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
4752 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
4753
4754- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
4755 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00004756 to the given FEC; i. e.
4757 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004758 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
4759
4760 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
4761
4762- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
4763 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
4764 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
4765
4766- CONFIG_RMII
4767 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
4768 Note that this is a global option, we can't
4769 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
4770
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004771- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
4772 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
4773 The syntax is:
4774
4775 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
4776
4777 Where address/count indicate a memory area
4778 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
4779 area should have.
4780
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004781- CONFIG_LOOPW
4782 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004783 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004784
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004785- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
4786 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
4787 "md/mw" commands.
4788 Examples:
4789
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004790 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004791 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
4792
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004793 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004794 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
4795
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004796 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004797 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004798
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004799- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004800 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004801 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
4802 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
4803 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004804
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004805 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
4806 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
4807 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
4808 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004809
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00004810- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02004811 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4812 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
4813 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00004814
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08004815- CONFIG_TPL_BUILD
4816 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4817 that is executed after the SPL and before the actual U-Boot.
4818 It is loaded by the SPL.
4819
Ying Zhang5df572f2013-05-20 14:07:23 +08004820- CONFIG_SYS_MPC85XX_NO_RESETVEC
4821 Only for 85xx systems. If this variable is specified, the section
4822 .resetvec is not kept and the section .bootpg is placed in the
4823 previous 4k of the .text section.
4824
Simon Glass4213fc22013-02-24 17:33:14 +00004825- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
4826 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
4827 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
4828 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
4829 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
4830 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
4831 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
4832 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
4833
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00004834- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
4835 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
4836 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
4837 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
4838 conditions but may increase the binary size.
4839
Simon Glass588a13f2013-02-14 04:18:54 +00004840- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
4841 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
4842 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Blackb16f5212012-11-27 21:08:06 +00004843
Mark Jacksonfc337052013-03-04 01:27:20 +00004844- CONFIG_SYS_MPUCLK
4845 Defines the MPU clock speed (in MHz).
4846
4847 NOTE : currently only supported on AM335x platforms.
Gabe Black5b5ece92012-11-29 16:23:41 +00004848
Heiko Schocher16678eb2013-11-04 14:05:00 +01004849- CONFIG_SPL_AM33XX_ENABLE_RTC32K_OSC:
4850 Enables the RTC32K OSC on AM33xx based plattforms
4851
Karicheri, Muralidharan999d7d32014-04-04 13:16:50 -04004852- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_NO_SUBPAGE_WRITE
4853 Option to disable subpage write in NAND driver
4854 driver that uses this:
4855 drivers/mtd/nand/davinci_nand.c
4856
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004857Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
4858-----------------------------------
4859
4860The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
4861loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
4862This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
4863are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
4864within that device.
4865
Zhao Qiangdcf1d772014-03-21 16:21:44 +08004866- CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR
4867 The address in the storage device where the FMAN microcode is located. The
4868 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
4869 is also specified.
4870
4871- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_ADDR
4872 The address in the storage device where the QE microcode is located. The
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004873 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
4874 is also specified.
4875
4876- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
4877 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
4878 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
4879 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
4880 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
4881
4882- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
4883 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
4884 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
4885 virtual address in NOR flash.
4886
4887- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
4888 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
4889 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
4890
4891- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
4892 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
4893 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
4894
4895- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
4896 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
4897 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
4898
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00004899- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
4900 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
4901 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004902 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
4903 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
4904 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004905
J. German Riverab940ca62014-06-23 15:15:55 -07004906Freescale Layerscape Management Complex Firmware Support:
4907---------------------------------------------------------
4908The Freescale Layerscape Management Complex (MC) supports the loading of
4909"firmware".
4910This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
4911are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
4912within that device.
4913
4914- CONFIG_FSL_MC_ENET
4915 Enable the MC driver for Layerscape SoCs.
4916
4917- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_ADDR
4918 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
4919 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_IN_xxx macro
4920 is also specified.
4921
4922- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_LENGTH
4923 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
4924 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
4925 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
4926 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
4927
4928- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_IN_NOR
4929 Specifies that MC firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
4930 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_ADDR is the
4931 virtual address in NOR flash.
4932
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004933Building the Software:
4934======================
4935
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004936Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
4937and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
4938all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
4939(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
4940recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
4941which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004942
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004943If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
4944have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
4945you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
4946Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
4947necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004948
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004949 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
4950 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004951
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05004952Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
4953 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
4954 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
4955 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
4956
4957 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
4958
4959 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
4960 be executed on computers running Windows.
4961
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004962U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
4963sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004964is done by typing:
4965
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004966 make NAME_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004967
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004968where "NAME_defconfig" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00004969rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00004970
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004971Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
4972 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
4973 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
4974 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004975 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004976
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004977 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004978 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004979
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004980 make TQM823L_LCD_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004981 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004982
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004983 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004984
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004985
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004986Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
4987images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004988
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004989- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
4990- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
4991- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004992
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004993By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
4994in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
4995this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
4996
49971. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
4998
4999 make O=/tmp/build distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005000 make O=/tmp/build NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005001 make O=/tmp/build all
5002
50032. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
5004
5005 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
5006 make distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005007 make NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005008 make all
5009
5010Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
5011variable.
5012
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005013
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005014Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
5015for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
5016native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005017
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005018
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005019If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
5020to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
5021steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005022
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000050231. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00005024 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
5025 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000050262. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
5027 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
5028 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
50293. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
5030 your board
50313. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
5032 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +020050334. Run "make <board>_defconfig" with your new name.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000050345. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
5035 to be installed on your target system.
50366. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
5037 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005038
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005039
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005040Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
5041==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005042
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005043If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
5044or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005045provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
5046the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005047official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005048
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005049But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
5050cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005051the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
5052just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005053for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
5054select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
5055environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
5056you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005057
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005058 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005059
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005060or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005061
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005062 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005063
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005064When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
5065U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
5066setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
5067built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
5068<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
5069location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
5070variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005071
5072 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
5073 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
5074 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
5075
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005076With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
5077log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
5078during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005079
5080
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005081See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005082
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005083
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005084Monitor Commands - Overview:
5085============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005086
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005087go - start application at address 'addr'
5088run - run commands in an environment variable
5089bootm - boot application image from memory
5090bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00005091bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005092tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
5093 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
5094 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00005095tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005096rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
5097diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
5098loads - load S-Record file over serial line
5099loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
5100md - memory display
5101mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
5102nm - memory modify (constant address)
5103mw - memory write (fill)
5104cp - memory copy
5105cmp - memory compare
5106crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05005107i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005108sspi - SPI utility commands
5109base - print or set address offset
5110printenv- print environment variables
5111setenv - set environment variables
5112saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
5113protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
5114erase - erase FLASH memory
5115flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc10635af2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00005116nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005117bdinfo - print Board Info structure
5118iminfo - print header information for application image
5119coninfo - print console devices and informations
5120ide - IDE sub-system
5121loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00005122loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005123mtest - simple RAM test
5124icache - enable or disable instruction cache
5125dcache - enable or disable data cache
5126reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
5127echo - echo args to console
5128version - print monitor version
5129help - print online help
5130? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005131
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005132
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005133Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
5134========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005135
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005136TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005137
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005138For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005139
5140
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005141Environment Variables:
5142======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005143
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005144U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
5145can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005146
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005147Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
5148"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
5149without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
5150environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
5151working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
5152environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005153
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005154Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
5155
5156List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005157
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005158 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005159
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005160 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005161
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005162 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005163
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005164 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005165
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005166 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005167
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02005168 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
5169 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
5170 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
5171 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
5172 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
5173 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00005174 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
5175 bootm_mapsize.
5176
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005177 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00005178 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
5179 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
5180 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
5181 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
5182 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
5183 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02005184
5185 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
5186 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
5187 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
5188 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
5189 environment variable.
5190
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02005191 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
5192 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
5193 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
5194
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005195 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
5196 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
5197 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
5198 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005199
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005200 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
5201 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
5202 be automatically started (by internally calling
5203 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005204
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005205 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
5206 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
5207 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
5208 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
5209 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005210
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04005211 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
5212 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00005213 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
5214 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
5215 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
5216 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
5217 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
5218 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
5219 access it during the boot procedure.
5220
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04005221 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
5222 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
5223 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
5224 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
5225 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
5226 must be accessible by the kernel.
5227
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00005228 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
5229 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
5230 defined.
5231
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00005232 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
5233 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
5234 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
5235 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
5236 it must be saved and board must be reset.
5237
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005238 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
5239 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
5240 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
5241 is usually what you want since it allows for
5242 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
5243 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005244 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005245 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
5246 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
5247 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
5248 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005249
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005250 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
5251 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
5252 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
5253 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
5254 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
5255 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005256
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005257 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005258
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005259 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
5260 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
5261 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
5262 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
5263 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
5264 boot time on your system, but requires that this
5265 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00005266
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005267 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005268
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005269 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
5270 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005271
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005272 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005273
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005274 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00005275
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005276 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005277
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005278 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005279
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005280 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005281
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00005282 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005283
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00005284 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
5285 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005286
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02005287 => setenv ethact FEC
5288 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
5289 => setenv ethact SCC
5290 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005291
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01005292 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
5293 available network interfaces.
5294 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
5295
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005296 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005297 either succeed or fail without retrying.
5298 When set to "once" the network operation will
5299 fail when all the available network interfaces
5300 are tried once without success.
5301 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
5302 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005303
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01005304 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01005305
Simon Glass8d51aac2013-07-16 20:10:00 -07005306 silent_linux - If set then linux will be told to boot silently, by
5307 changing the console to be empty. If "yes" it will be
5308 made silent. If "no" it will not be made silent. If
5309 unset, then it will be made silent if the U-Boot console
5310 is silent.
5311
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02005312 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02005313 UDP source port.
5314
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02005315 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
5316 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
5317
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005318 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
5319 we use the TFTP server's default block size
5320
5321 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
5322 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
5323 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
5324 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
5325 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
5326 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
5327 with unreliable TFTP servers.
5328
5329 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005330 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005331 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005332
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005333The following image location variables contain the location of images
5334used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
5335not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
5336variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
5337server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
5338loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
5339flash or offset in NAND flash.
5340
5341*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
5342boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
5343boards use these variables for other purposes.
5344
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005345Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
5346----- --------- ----------- --------------
5347u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
5348Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
5349device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
5350ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005351
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005352The following environment variables may be used and automatically
5353updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
5354depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005355
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005356 bootfile - see above
5357 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
5358 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
5359 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
5360 hostname - Target hostname
5361 ipaddr - see above
5362 netmask - Subnet Mask
5363 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
5364 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005365
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005366
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005367There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005368
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005369 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
5370 as type string and/or serial number
5371 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005372
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005373These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
5374the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
5375once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005376
5377
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005378Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005379
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005380 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
5381 with the "version" command. This variable is
5382 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005383
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005384
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005385Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
5386only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005387
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005388
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005389Callback functions for environment variables:
5390---------------------------------------------
5391
5392For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
5393when their values are changed. This functionailty allows functions to
5394be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
5395deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
5396effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
5397
5398The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
5399U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
5400
5401These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
5402static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
5403in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
5404associations. The list must be in the following format:
5405
5406 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
5407 list = entry[,list]
5408
5409If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
5410Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
5411
5412Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
5413with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
5414override any association in the static list. You can define
5415CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
5416".callbacks" envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
5417
5418
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005419Command Line Parsing:
5420=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005421
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005422There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
5423the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005424
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005425Old, simple command line parser:
5426--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005427
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005428- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
5429- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01005430- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005431- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
5432 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01005433 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005434- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
5435 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005436
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005437Hush shell:
5438-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005439
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005440- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
5441 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
5442 until...do...done, ...
5443- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
5444 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
5445 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
5446 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005447
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005448General rules:
5449--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005450
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005451(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
5452 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
5453 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
5454 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005455
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005456(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005457 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005458 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
5459 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005460
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005461Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
5462=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005463
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005464Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005465such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
5466"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005467
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005468Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
5469MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
5470"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005471
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005472If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
5473in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
5474ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
5475variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005476
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005477o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
5478 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005479
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005480o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
5481 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
5482 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005483
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005484o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
5485 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005486
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005487o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
5488 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
5489 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005490
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005491o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
5492 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005493
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005494If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005495will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005496may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
5497The naming convention is as follows:
5498"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005499
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005500Image Formats:
5501==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005502
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01005503U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
5504images in two formats:
5505
5506New uImage format (FIT)
5507-----------------------
5508
5509Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
5510to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
5511components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
5512SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
5513
5514
5515Old uImage format
5516-----------------
5517
5518Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
5519preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
5520details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005521
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005522* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
5523 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05005524 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
5525 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
5526 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02005527* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005528 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
5529 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005530* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
5531* Load Address
5532* Entry Point
5533* Image Name
5534* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005535
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005536The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
5537and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
5538CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005539
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005540
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005541Linux Support:
5542==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005543
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005544Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
5545easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
5546U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005547
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005548U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
5549special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
5550"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
5551instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
5552serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005553
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005554- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
5555 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
5556 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005557
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005558- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
5559 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005560
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005561- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
5562 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
5563 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
5564 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
5565 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
5566 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005567
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005568
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005569Linux HOWTO:
5570============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005571
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005572Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
5573---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005574
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005575U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
5576configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
5577(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
5578Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005579
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005580But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005581
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005582Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
5583include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02005584Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
5585and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005586as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005587
Simon Glass2eb31b12014-06-11 23:29:46 -06005588Note that U-Boot now has a driver model, a unified model for drivers.
5589If you are adding a new driver, plumb it into driver model. If there
5590is no uclass available, you are encouraged to create one. See
5591doc/driver-model.
5592
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005593
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005594Configuring the Linux kernel:
5595-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005596
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005597No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
5598device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005599
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005600
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005601Building a Linux Image:
5602-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005603
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005604With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
5605not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
5606"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
5607U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
5608which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
5609100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005610
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005611Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005612
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005613 make TQM850L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005614 make oldconfig
5615 make dep
5616 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005617
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005618The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
5619encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
5620CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005621
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005622* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005623
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005624* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005625
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005626 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
5627 -R .note -R .comment \
5628 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005629
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005630* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005631
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005632 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005633
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005634* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005635
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005636 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
5637 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
5638 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005639
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005640
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005641The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
5642with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
5643combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
5644byte header containing information about target architecture,
5645operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
5646stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005647
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005648"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
5649print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005650
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005651In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
5652contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
5653checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005654
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005655 tools/mkimage -l image
5656 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005657
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005658The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
5659from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005660
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005661 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
5662 -n name -d data_file image
5663 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
5664 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
5665 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
5666 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
5667 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
5668 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
5669 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
5670 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005671
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00005672Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
5673address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
5674kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005675
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005676- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
5677- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005678
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005679So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005680
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005681 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5682 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005683 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005684 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
5685 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5686 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5687 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5688 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5689 Load Address: 0x00000000
5690 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005691
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005692To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005693
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005694 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
5695 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5696 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5697 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5698 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5699 Load Address: 0x00000000
5700 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005701
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005702NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
5703speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
5704needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
5705need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005706
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005707 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005708 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5709 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005710 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005711 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
5712 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5713 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5714 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
5715 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
5716 Load Address: 0x00000000
5717 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005718
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005719
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005720Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
5721when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005722
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005723 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
5724 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
5725 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
5726 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5727 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
5728 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5729 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
5730 Load Address: 0x00000000
5731 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005732
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraa804b5c2013-12-01 12:43:11 -07005733The "dumpimage" is a tool to disassemble images built by mkimage. Its "-i"
5734option performs the converse operation of the mkimage's second form (the "-d"
5735option). Given an image built by mkimage, the dumpimage extracts a "data file"
5736from the image:
5737
5738 tools/dumpimage -i image -p position data_file
5739 -i ==> extract from the 'image' a specific 'data_file', \
5740 indexed by 'position'
5741
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005742
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005743Installing a Linux Image:
5744-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005745
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005746To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
5747you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005748
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005749 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005750
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005751The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
5752image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
5753address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
5754specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
5755command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005756
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005757Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
5758TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005759
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005760 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005761
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005762 .......... done
5763 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005764
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005765 => loads 40100000
5766 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5767 ~>examples/image.srec
5768 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
5769 ...
5770 15989 15990 15991 15992
5771 [file transfer complete]
5772 [connected]
5773 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005774
5775
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005776You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005777this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005778corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005779
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005780 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005781
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005782 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5783 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5784 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5785 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5786 Load Address: 00000000
5787 Entry Point: 0000000c
5788 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005789
5790
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005791Boot Linux:
5792-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005793
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005794The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
5795memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
5796of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
5797parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
5798"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005799
5800
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005801 => printenv bootargs
5802 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005803
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005804 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005805
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005806 => printenv bootargs
5807 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005808
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005809 => bootm 40020000
5810 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
5811 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
5812 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5813 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
5814 Load Address: 00000000
5815 Entry Point: 0000000c
5816 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5817 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5818 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
5819 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
5820 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
5821 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
5822 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
5823 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005824
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005825If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005826the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
5827format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005828
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005829 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005830
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005831 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5832 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5833 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5834 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5835 Load Address: 00000000
5836 Entry Point: 0000000c
5837 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005838
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005839 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
5840 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5841 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5842 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
5843 Load Address: 00000000
5844 Entry Point: 00000000
5845 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005846
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005847 => bootm 40100000 40200000
5848 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
5849 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5850 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5851 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5852 Load Address: 00000000
5853 Entry Point: 0000000c
5854 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5855 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5856 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
5857 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5858 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5859 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
5860 Load Address: 00000000
5861 Entry Point: 00000000
5862 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5863 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
5864 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
5865 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
5866 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
5867 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
5868 ...
5869 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
5870 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005871
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005872 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005873
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005874Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
5875-----------
5876
5877First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
5878titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
5879following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
5880flat device tree:
5881
5882=> print oftaddr
5883oftaddr=0x300000
5884=> print oft
5885oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
5886=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
5887Speed: 1000, full duplex
5888Using TSEC0 device
5889TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
5890Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
5891Load address: 0x300000
5892Loading: #
5893done
5894Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
5895=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
5896Speed: 1000, full duplex
5897Using TSEC0 device
5898TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
5899Filename 'uImage'.
5900Load address: 0x200000
5901Loading:############
5902done
5903Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
5904=> print loadaddr
5905loadaddr=200000
5906=> print oftaddr
5907oftaddr=0x300000
5908=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
5909## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01005910 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
5911 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5912 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005913 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01005914 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005915 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5916 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5917Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
5918Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
5919Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
5920[snip]
5921
5922
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005923More About U-Boot Image Types:
5924------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005925
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005926U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005927
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005928 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
5929 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
5930 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
5931 the Standalone Program.
5932 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
5933 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
5934 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
5935 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
5936 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
5937 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
5938 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
5939 being started.
5940 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
5941 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
5942 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
5943 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
5944 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
5945 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005946
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005947 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
5948 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
5949 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
5950 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
5951 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
5952 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005953
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005954 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
5955 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
5956 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005957
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005958 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
5959 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
5960 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
5961 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005962
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00005963Booting the Linux zImage:
5964-------------------------
5965
5966On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
5967using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
5968as the syntax of "bootm" command.
5969
Tom Rini8ac28562013-05-16 11:40:11 -04005970Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_RAW_INITRD allows user to supply
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00005971kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
5972address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
5973format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
5974
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005975
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005976Standalone HOWTO:
5977=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005978
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005979One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
5980run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
5981U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005982
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005983Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005984
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005985"Hello World" Demo:
5986-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005987
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005988'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
5989application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
5990It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
5991like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005992
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005993 => loads
5994 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5995 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
5996 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
5997 [file transfer complete]
5998 [connected]
5999 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006000
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006001 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
6002 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
6003 Hello World
6004 argc = 7
6005 argv[0] = "40004"
6006 argv[1] = "Hello"
6007 argv[2] = "World!"
6008 argv[3] = "This"
6009 argv[4] = "is"
6010 argv[5] = "a"
6011 argv[6] = "test."
6012 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
6013 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006014
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006015 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006016
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006017Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
6018handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
6019Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
6020The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
6021character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
6022controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006023
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006024 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
6025 b - enable interrupts and start timer
6026 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
6027 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006028
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006029 => loads
6030 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
6031 ~>examples/timer.srec
6032 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
6033 [file transfer complete]
6034 [connected]
6035 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006036
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006037 => go 40004
6038 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
6039 TIMERS=0xfff00980
6040 Using timer 1
6041 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006042
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006043Hit 'b':
6044 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
6045 Enabling timer
6046Hit '?':
6047 [q, b, e, ?] ........
6048 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
6049Hit '?':
6050 [q, b, e, ?] .
6051 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
6052Hit '?':
6053 [q, b, e, ?] .
6054 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
6055Hit '?':
6056 [q, b, e, ?] .
6057 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
6058Hit 'e':
6059 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
6060Hit 'q':
6061 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006062
6063
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006064Minicom warning:
6065================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00006066
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006067Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
6068"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
6069consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
6070Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
6071especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00006072use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
6073http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
6074for help with kermit.
6075
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00006076
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006077Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
6078configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006079
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006080 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
6081 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
6082 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006083
6084
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006085NetBSD Notes:
6086=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006087
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006088Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
6089(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006090
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006091Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
6092NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
6093need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
6094Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
6095attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
6096missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006097
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006098 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
6099 # mkdir powerpc
6100 # ln -s powerpc machine
6101 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
6102 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006103
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006104Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
6105and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006106
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006107Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
6108stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
6109proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
6110tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00006111meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006112
6113
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006114Implementation Internals:
6115=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006116
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006117The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
6118implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
6119inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
6120hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006121
6122
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006123Initial Stack, Global Data:
6124---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006125
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006126The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
6127starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
6128system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
6129This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
6130is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
6131at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
6132options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
6133models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
6134MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
6135locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006136
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006137 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006138 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006139
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006140 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
6141 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
6142 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
6143 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006144
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006145 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
6146 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
6147 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
6148 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
6149 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006150 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006151 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
6152 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006153
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006154 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
6155 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006156 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006157 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
6158 board designers haven't used it for something that would
6159 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
6160 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006161
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02006162 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006163 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
6164 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02006165 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006166 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
6167 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
6168 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
6169 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
6170 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006171
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006172 -Chris Hallinan
6173 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006174
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006175It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
6176code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006177
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006178* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
6179 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006180
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006181* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006182 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
6183 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006184
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006185* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
6186 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006187
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006188Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
6189normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
6190turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
6191simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
6192functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
6193functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
6194the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
6195place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
6196reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006197
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006198When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
6199relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
6200GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006201
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006202For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
6203 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01006204 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006205 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
6206 R5-R10: parameter passing
6207 R13: small data area pointer
6208 R30: GOT pointer
6209 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006210
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01006211 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
6212 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
6213 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006214
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01006215 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006216
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006217 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
6218 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
6219 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
6220 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
6221 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
6222 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006223
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00006224On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05006225 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
6226
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00006227 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05006228
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006229On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006230
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006231 R0: function argument word/integer result
6232 R1-R3: function argument word
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02006233 R9: platform specific
6234 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking is enabled)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006235 R11: argument (frame) pointer
6236 R12: temporary workspace
6237 R13: stack pointer
6238 R14: link register
6239 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006240
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02006241 ==> U-Boot will use R9 to hold a pointer to the global data
6242
6243 Note: on ARM, only R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations are supported.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006244
Thomas Chou0df01fd32010-05-21 11:08:03 +08006245On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
6246 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
6247
6248 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
6249
6250 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
6251 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
6252
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00006253On NDS32, the following registers are used:
6254
6255 R0-R1: argument/return
6256 R2-R5: argument
6257 R15: temporary register for assembler
6258 R16: trampoline register
6259 R28: frame pointer (FP)
6260 R29: global pointer (GP)
6261 R30: link register (LP)
6262 R31: stack pointer (SP)
6263 PC: program counter (PC)
6264
6265 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
6266
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02006267NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
6268or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006269
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006270Memory Management:
6271------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006272
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006273U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
6274MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006275
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006276The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
6277controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
6278memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
6279physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006280
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006281U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
6282TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
6283booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
6284to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02006285memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006286configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
6287Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006288
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006289Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
6290of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006291
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006292So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
6293this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006294
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006295 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
6296 :
6297 0x0000 1FFF
6298 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
6299 :
6300 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006301
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006302 :
6303 :
6304 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
6305 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
6306 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
6307 :
6308 0x00FD FFFF
6309 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
6310 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
6311 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
6312 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006313
6314
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006315System Initialization:
6316----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006317
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006318In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006319(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006320configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
6321To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
6322To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
6323initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
6324which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
6325part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
6326the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006327
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006328Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
6329preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
6330(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
6331on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
6332programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
6333simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
6334banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006335
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006336When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
6337different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
6338bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
63390x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
6340contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006341
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006342Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
6343and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
6344Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
6345pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006346
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006347Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
6348until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
6349running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
6350new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006351
6352
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006353U-Boot Porting Guide:
6354----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006355
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006356[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
6357list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006358
6359
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006360int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006361{
6362 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006363
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006364 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
6365 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006366
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006367 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006368 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006369 return 0;
6370 }
6371
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006372 Download latest U-Boot source;
6373
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006374 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006375
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006376 if (clueless)
6377 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006378
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006379 while (learning) {
6380 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006381 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
6382 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006383 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006384 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006385 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006386
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006387 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
6388 Buy a BDI3000;
6389 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006390 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006391
6392 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
6393 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
6394 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
6395 } else {
6396 Create your own board support subdirectory;
6397 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006398 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006399 Edit new board/<myboard> files
6400 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006401
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006402 while (!accepted) {
6403 while (!running) {
6404 do {
6405 Add / modify source code;
6406 } until (compiles);
6407 Debug;
6408 if (clueless)
6409 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
6410 }
6411 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
6412 if (reasonable critiques)
6413 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
6414 else
6415 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006416 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006417
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006418 return 0;
6419}
6420
6421void no_more_time (int sig)
6422{
6423 hire_a_guru();
6424}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006425
6426
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006427Coding Standards:
6428-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006429
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006430All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006431coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006432"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006433
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006434Source files originating from a different project (for example the
6435MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
6436reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
6437sources.
6438
6439Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
6440Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
6441in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006442
6443Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
6444- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006445- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006446- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006447- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006448- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
6449
6450Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
6451with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006452
6453
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006454Submitting Patches:
6455-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006456
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006457Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
6458establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
6459may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006460
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02006461Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006462
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006463Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
6464see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
6465
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006466When you send a patch, please include the following information with
6467it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006468
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006469* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
6470 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
6471 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006472
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006473* For new features: a description of the feature and your
6474 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006475
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006476* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
6477
6478* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
6479
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +02006480* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add a
6481 maintainer e-mail address to the boards.cfg file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006482
6483* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
6484 document these in the README file.
6485
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006486* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
6487 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006488 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006489 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
6490 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006491
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006492 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
6493 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
6494 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006495
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006496 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
6497 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
6498 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
6499 affected files).
6500
6501 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
6502 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006503
6504* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
6505 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
6506
6507* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
6508 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
6509
6510
6511Notes:
6512
6513* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
6514 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
6515 for any of the boards.
6516
6517* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
6518 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
6519 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
6520
6521* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
6522 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
6523 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
6524 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
6525 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
6526 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00006527
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006528* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
6529 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
6530 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
6531 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.